blob: e65b0731f768d439e9f013bc6fa51b050317c1fe [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau910d5ac2019-12-21 12:45:18 +01007 2019/12/21
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200587 - h1-case-adjust
588 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100591 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200593 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200595 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200596 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100598 - presetenv
599 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600 - uid
601 - ulimit-n
602 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200603 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100604 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200605 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-bind-options
609 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200610 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - ssl-default-server-options
612 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100613 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100616 - 51degrees-data-file
617 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200618 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200619 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-data-file
621 - wurfl-information-list
622 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200623 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200626 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200628 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100629 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100630 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100631 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200632 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200633 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200634 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200635 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - noepoll
637 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000638 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100640 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000642 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100643 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200644 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200645 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200646 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000647 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000648 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200649 - tune.buffers.limit
650 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200651 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200652 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100653 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200654 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200655 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200656 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100657 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200658 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200659 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100660 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100662 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100663 - tune.lua.session-timeout
664 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200665 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100666 - tune.maxaccept
667 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200669 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200670 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100671 - tune.rcvbuf.client
672 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100673 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200674 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100675 - tune.sndbuf.client
676 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100677 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200679 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100680 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200681 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200682 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100683 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100685 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200686 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
687 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
688 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100689 - tune.zlib.memlevel
690 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692 * Debugging
693 - debug
694 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698------------------------------------
699
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200700ca-base <dir>
701 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200702 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
703 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705chroot <jail dir>
706 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
707 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
708 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
709 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
710 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100713cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
714 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
715 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
716 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
717 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
718 set. These sets have the format
719
720 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
721
722 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
725 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100726 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
727 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100729 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
733 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
734 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
735 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100736
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100737 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
738 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
739 on the machine's word size.
740
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
743 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
744 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
745 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
746 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
747 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100748
749 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
751
752 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
753 # first 4 CPUs
754
755 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
756 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
757 # word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
763 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
764
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
766 # and so on.
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
769 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100771 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
773 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
774 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
775
776 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
777 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
778 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
779
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100780 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
781 # and a thread range.
782 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
784 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
785
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200786crt-base <dir>
787 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
788 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
789 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791daemon
792 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
793 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100794 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
795 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200797deviceatlas-json-file <path>
798 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200800
801deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100802 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200803 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
804
805deviceatlas-separator <char>
806 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
807 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
808
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100809deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200810 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
811 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
812 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100813
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900814external-check
815 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
816 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
817 See "option external-check".
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819gid <number>
820 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
821 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
822 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100823 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
824 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100827group <group name>
828 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
829 See also "gid" and "user".
830
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100831hard-stop-after <time>
832 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
833
834 Arguments :
835 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
836 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
837 SIGUSR1 signal.
838
839 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
840 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
841 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
842
843 Example:
844 global
845 hard-stop-after 30s
846
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200847h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
848 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
849 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
850 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
851 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
852 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
853 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
854 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
855 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
856 specified in a proxy.
857
858 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
859 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
860 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
861 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
862 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
863 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
864 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
865
866 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
867 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
868 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
869 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
870 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
871
872 Example:
873 global
874 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
875
876 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
877 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
878
879h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
880 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
881 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
882 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
883 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
884 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
885 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
886 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
887 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
888
889 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
890 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
891 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
892
893 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
894 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
895
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200896log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
897 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100898 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100900 configured with "log global".
901
902 <address> can be one of:
903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100904 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100905 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
906 port).
907
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100908 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
909 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
910 port).
911
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100912 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
914 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100915 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100917 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
918 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
919 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
920 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
921 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
922 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
923 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
924 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
925 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
926 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
927 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
928 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
929 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
930 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100931 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
932 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100933
934 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
935 "fd@2", see above.
936
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200937 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
938 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100939
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200940 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
941 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
942 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
943 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
944 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
945 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
946 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
947 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
948 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
949 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100950 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
951 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200952
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200953 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
954 one of the following :
955
956 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
957 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
958
959 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
960 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
961
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100962 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
963 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
964 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
965 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
966 logger consumes.
967
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100968 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
969 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
970 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
971 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
972
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200973 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
974 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
975 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
976 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
977 set with <sample_size> parameter.
978
979 <sample_size>
980 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
981 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
982 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
983 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
984 (see also <ranges> parameter).
985
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100988 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
989 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
990 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
991
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100992 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
993 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
994 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
995 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996
997 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200998 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
999 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1000 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1001 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1002 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1003 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001005 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001007log-send-hostname [<string>]
1008 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1009 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1010 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1011 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1012 the logs.
1013
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001014log-tag <string>
1015 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1016 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1017 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001018 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001019
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001020lua-load <file>
1021 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1022 used multiple times.
1023
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001024master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001025 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1026 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1027 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001028 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001029 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1030 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001031 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1032 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1033 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1034 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1035 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001036
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001037 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001038
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001039mworker-max-reloads <number>
1040 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001041 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001042 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1043 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1044 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1045
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001046nbproc <number>
1047 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1048 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1049 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001050 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1051 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001052 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1053 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001055nbthread <number>
1056 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001057 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1058 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1059 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1060 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1061 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001062 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1063 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1064 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1065 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1066 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1067 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1068 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001071 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1073 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1074
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001075presetenv <name> <value>
1076 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1077 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1078 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1079 and "unsetenv".
1080
1081resetenv [<name> ...]
1082 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1083 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1084 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1085 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1086 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1087 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1088 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1089 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1090
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001091stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001092 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1093 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1094 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1095 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1096 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1097 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001098 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001099 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1100 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1101 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1102 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001103
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001104server-state-base <directory>
1105 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001106 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1107 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001108
1109server-state-file <file>
1110 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1111 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1112 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1113 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1114 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1115 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1116 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1117 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001118 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1119 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001120
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001121setenv <name> <value>
1122 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1123 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1124 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1125 and "unsetenv".
1126
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001127set-dumpable
1128 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1129 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1130 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1131 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1132 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1133 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1134 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1135 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1136 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1137 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1138 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1139 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1140 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1141 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1142 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1143 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1144 expected when dying.
1145
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001146ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1148 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001149 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001150 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001151 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1152 information and recommendations see e.g.
1153 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1154 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1155 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1156 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001157
1158ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1160 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1161 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1162 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1163 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001164 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1165 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1166 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001167 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001168
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001169ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1171 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1172 keyword to see available options.
1173
1174 Example:
1175 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001176 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001177
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001178ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1180 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001181 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001182 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001183 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1184 information and recommendations see e.g.
1185 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1186 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1187 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1188 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1189 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001190
1191ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1193 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1194 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1195 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1196 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1198 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1199 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1200 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001201
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001202ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1204 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1205 keyword to see available options.
1206
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001207ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1210 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001211 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001212 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001213 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1214 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1215 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1216 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001217 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1218 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1219 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1220
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001221ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1222 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1223 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1224 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1225
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001226stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1227 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1228 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1229 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001230 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001231 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001232
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001233 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1234 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1235 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001236
1237stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1238 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1239 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001240 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001241
1242stats maxconn <connections>
1243 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1244 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001246uid <number>
1247 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1248 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1249 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1250 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1251
1252ulimit-n <number>
1253 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1254 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1255 option.
1256
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001257unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1258 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1259
1260 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1261 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1262 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1263 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1264 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1265 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1266 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1267 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1268 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1269 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1270
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001271unsetenv [<name> ...]
1272 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1273 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1274 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1275 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1276 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1277 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1278 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1279
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001280user <user name>
1281 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1282 See also "uid" and "group".
1283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001284node <name>
1285 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1286
1287 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1288 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1289 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1290 traffic.
1291
1292description <text>
1293 Add a text that describes the instance.
1294
1295 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1296 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1297 "<" and ">" characters.
1298
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129951degrees-data-file <file path>
1300 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001301 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001302
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001304 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1305
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001307 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1308 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1309 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1310
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001311 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1313
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001315 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1316 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1317
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001318 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1320
132151degrees-cache-size <number>
1322 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1323 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1324 By default, this cache is disabled.
1325
1326 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001327 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1328
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001329wurfl-data-file <file path>
1330 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1331 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1332
1333 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1334 with USE_WURFL=1.
1335
1336wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1337 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1338 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1339 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1340
1341 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1342
1343 Valid WURFL properties are:
1344 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1345
1346 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1347 device.
1348
1349 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1350 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1351
1352 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1353 particular web request.
1354
1355 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1356 used Libwurfl API version.
1357
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001358 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1359 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1360
1361 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1362 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1363
1364 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1365
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001366 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1367 with USE_WURFL=1.
1368
1369wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1370 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1371 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1372
1373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1374 with USE_WURFL=1.
1375
1376wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1377 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1378 thus before the chroot.
1379
1380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001383wurfl-cache-size <size>
1384 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1385 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001387 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001388
1389 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1390 with USE_WURFL=1.
1391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393-----------------------
1394
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001395busy-polling
1396 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1397 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1398 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1399 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1400 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1401 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1402 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1403 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1404 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1405 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1406 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1407 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1408 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1409 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1410 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1411 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1412 "poll" pollers.
1413
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001414 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1415 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1416 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1417
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001418max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1419 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1420 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1421 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1422 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1423 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1424 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1425 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1426 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428maxconn <number>
1429 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1430 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1431 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001432 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1433 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1434 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1435 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001436 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1437 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1438 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1439 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1440 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1441 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001442
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001443maxconnrate <number>
1444 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1445 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1446 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1447 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1448 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1449 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1450 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1451 fairness.
1452
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001453maxcomprate <number>
1454 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001455 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001456 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1457 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1458 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001459 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001460 default value.
1461
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001462maxcompcpuusage <number>
1463 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1464 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1465 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1466 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1467 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1468 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1469 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1470 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1471
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001472maxpipes <number>
1473 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1474 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1475 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1476 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1477 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1478 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1479
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001480maxsessrate <number>
1481 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1482 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1483 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1484 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1485 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1486 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1487 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1488 fairness.
1489
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001490maxsslconn <number>
1491 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1492 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1493 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1494 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1495 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1496 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1497 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001498 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1499 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1500 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1501 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1502 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1503 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1504 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001505
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001506maxsslrate <number>
1507 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1508 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1509 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1510 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1511 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1512 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1513 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1514 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1515 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1516 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1517
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001518maxzlibmem <number>
1519 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1520 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1521 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001522 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1523 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1524 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001526noepoll
1527 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1528 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001529 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001530
1531nokqueue
1532 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1533 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1534 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1535
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001536noevports
1537 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1538 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1539 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1540 also "nopoll".
1541
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001542nopoll
1543 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1544 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001546 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1547 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001549nosplice
1550 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001551 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001552 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001553 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001554 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1555 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1556 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1557 "option splice-response".
1558
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001559nogetaddrinfo
1560 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1561 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1562
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001563noreuseport
1564 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1565 command line argument "-dR".
1566
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001567profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1568 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1569 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1570 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1571 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001572 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001573 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1574 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1575 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1576 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1577
1578 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1579 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1580 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1581 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1582 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001583 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1584 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1585 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1586 CLI.
1587
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001588spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001589 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1590 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1591 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1592 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1593 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1594 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001596ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001597 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001598 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001599 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1600 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1601 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1602 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1603 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1605 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001606 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1607 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1608 openssl configuration file uses:
1609 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1610
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001611ssl-mode-async
1612 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001613 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001614 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1615 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1616 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001617 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001618 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001619
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001620tune.buffers.limit <number>
1621 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1622 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1623 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1624 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1625 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001626 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001627 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1628 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1629 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1630 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1631 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1632 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1633 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1634 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1635 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1636
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001637tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1638 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1639 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1640 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1641 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1642
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001643tune.bufsize <number>
1644 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1645 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1646 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1647 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1648 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1649 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1650 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001651 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1652 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1653 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001654 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001655 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1656 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1657 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001658
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001659tune.chksize <number>
1660 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1661 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1662 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1663 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1664 checks whenever possible.
1665
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001666tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1667 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1668 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1669 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1670 this value. The default value is 1.
1671
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001672tune.fail-alloc
1673 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1674 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1675 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1676 gracefully.
1677
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001678tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1679 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1680 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1681 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1682 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1683 change it.
1684
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001685tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1686 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1688 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001689 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1690 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1691 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1692 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1693 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1694
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001695tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1696 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1697 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1698 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1699 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1700 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1701 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1702 recommended not to change this value.
1703
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001704tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1705 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1706 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1707 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1708 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1709 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1710 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1711 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1712
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001713tune.http.cookielen <number>
1714 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1715 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1716 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1717 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1718 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1719 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1720 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1721 to change this value.
1722
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001723tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001724 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1725 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001726 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001727 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001728 configuration directives too.
1729 The default value is 1024.
1730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1739 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1740 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001741
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001742tune.idletimer <timeout>
1743 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1744 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1745 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1746 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1747 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1748 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001750 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001751 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1752
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001753tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1754 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1755 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1756 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1757 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1758 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1759 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1760 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1761 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1762 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1763
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001764tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1765 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001766 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001767 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1768 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001769 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001770 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1771 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1772
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001773tune.lua.maxmem
1774 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1775 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1776 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1777 memory.
1778
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001779tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1780 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001781 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1782 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001783 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001784
1785tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1786 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1787 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1788 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1789 check servers.
1790
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001791tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1792 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1793 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1794 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001795 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001796
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001797tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001798 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1799 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1800 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1801 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1802 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1803 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1804 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1805 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1806 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1807 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001808
1809tune.maxpollevents <number>
1810 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1811 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1812 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1813 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1814 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1815
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001816tune.maxrewrite <number>
1817 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1818 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1819 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1820 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1821 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1822 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1823 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1824 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1825 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1826 bufsize.
1827
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001828tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1829 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1830 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1831 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1832 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1833 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1834 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1835 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1836 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1837 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001838 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1839 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001840 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1841 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1842 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1843 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1844 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1845 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1846 setting this parameter to 0.
1847
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001848tune.pipesize <number>
1849 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1850 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1851 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1852 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1853 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1854 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1855
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001856tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1857 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1858 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1859 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1860 default is 20.
1861
1862tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1863 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1864 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1865 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1866 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1867 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1868 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001869 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001870
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001871tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1872tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1873 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1874 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001876 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1880
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001881tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001883 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1884 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1885 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1886 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1887
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001888tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001889 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001890 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1891 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1892
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001893tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1894tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1895 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1896 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1897 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001898 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001900 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1901 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1902 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1903 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1904 notifying haproxy again.
1905
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001906tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001907 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1908 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1909 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001910 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001911 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001912 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001913 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1914 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1915 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001916 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1917 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001918
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001919tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001920 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001921 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1922 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1923 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1924 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1925 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1926
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001927tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1928 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001929 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001930 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1931 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1932 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1933 being used for too long.
1934
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001935tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1936 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1937 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1938 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1939 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1940 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1941 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1942 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1943 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1944 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1945 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001947 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001948
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001949tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1950 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1951 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1952 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1953 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1954 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1955 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1956 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001957 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1958 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001959
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001960tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1961 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1962 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1963 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1964 1000 entries.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001966tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1967 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1968 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1969 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001971tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001972tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001973tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1975tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001976 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1977 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1978 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1979 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1980 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1981 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1982 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1983 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001984
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001985 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1986 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1987 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1988 all available space is consumed.
1989 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1990 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1991 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001992
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001993tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1994 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001995 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001996 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001998 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1999
2000tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2001 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2002 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002003 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2004 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020063.3. Debugging
2007--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002008
2009debug
2010 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2011 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2012 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2013 system startup.
2014
2015quiet
2016 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2017 line argument "-q".
2018
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020203.4. Userlists
2021--------------
2022It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2023http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2024it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2025
2026userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002027 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002028 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2029
2030group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002031 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002032 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2033 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2034
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002035user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2036 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002037 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2038 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002039 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2040 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2041 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2042 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002043
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002044 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2045 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2046 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2047 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2048 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2049 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2050 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2051 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2052 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053
2054 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002055 userlist L1
2056 group G1 users tiger,scott
2057 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002059 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2060 user scott insecure-password elgato
2061 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002062
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002063 userlist L2
2064 group G1
2065 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002066
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002067 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2068 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2069 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002070
2071 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002073
20743.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002075----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002076It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2077several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2078instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2079values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2080automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2081In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2082using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2083tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2084reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2085Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2086that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2087each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
2089peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002090 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002091 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2092
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002093bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2094 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2095 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2096
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002097disabled
2098 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2099 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2100 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2101
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002102default-bind [param*]
2103 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2104
2105default-server [param*]
2106 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2107
2108 Arguments:
2109 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2110 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2111 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2112 details.
2113
2114
2115 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2116
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002117enable
2118 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2119
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002120peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002121 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2122 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2123 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2124 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2125 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2126 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2127
2128 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2129 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2130
2131 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2132 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2133 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2134 across all peers.
2135
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002136 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2137 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002138
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002139 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2140 "server" keyword explanation below).
2141
2142server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002143 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002144 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2145 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2146 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2147 of this "peers" section).
2148 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2149
2150
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002151 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002152 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002153 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002154 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2155 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2156 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002157
2158 backend mybackend
2159 mode tcp
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2162 stick on src
2163
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002164 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2165 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002166
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002167 Example:
2168 peers mypeers
2169 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2170 default-server ssl verify none
2171 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2172 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002173
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002174
2175table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2176 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2177
2178 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2179 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002180 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002181 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2182 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2183 "stick-table" keyword).
2184
2185 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2186 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2187 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2188 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2189 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2190 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2191 of the stick-table name as follows:
2192
2193 peers mypeers
2194 peer A ...
2195 peer B ...
2196 table t1 ...
2197
2198 frontend fe1
2199 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2200
2201 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2202 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2203
2204 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2205 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2206 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2207 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2208 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2209 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2210 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2211
2212 peers mypeers
2213 peer A ...
2214 peer B ...
2215 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2216
2217 backend t1
2218 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2219
2220 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2221 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2222 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2223
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022243.6. Mailers
2225------------
2226It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2227If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2228in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2229
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002230mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002231 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2232 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2233
2234mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2235 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2236
2237 Example:
2238 mailers mymailers
2239 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2240 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2241
2242 backend mybackend
2243 mode tcp
2244 balance roundrobin
2245
2246 email-alert mailers mymailers
2247 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2248 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2249
2250 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2251 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2252
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002253timeout mail <time>
2254 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2255 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2256 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2257 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2258
2259 Example:
2260 mailers mymailers
2261 timeout mail 20s
2262 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002263
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022643.7. Programs
2265-------------
2266In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2267master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2268managed the same way as the workers.
2269
2270During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2271sequence as a worker:
2272
2273 - the master is re-executed
2274 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2275 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2276 instance of the program
2277
2278During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2279
2280program <name>
2281 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2282 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2283 the management guide).
2284
2285command <command> [arguments*]
2286 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2287 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2288 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2289 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2290
2291option start-on-reload
2292no option start-on-reload
2293 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2294 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2295 program section.
2296
2297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002302 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303 - frontend <name>
2304 - backend <name>
2305 - listen <name>
2306
2307A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2308its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2309section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
2312A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2313connections.
2314
2315A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2316to forward incoming connections.
2317
2318A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2319parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2322'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2323case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2324
2325Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2326logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2327proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2328However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2329name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2330
2331Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2332and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002333bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2335modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2336arbitrary criteria.
2337
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002338In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2339a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002340the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002341
2342 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2343 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2344 between responses and new requests.
2345
2346 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2347 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2348 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002349 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2350 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2351 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2352 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002354 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2355 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2356 client-facing connection remains open.
2357
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002358 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2359 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002360
2361The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2362frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2363following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002364weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002365
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002366 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2369 ----+-----+-----+----
2370 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2371 ----+-----+-----+----
2372 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2373 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2374 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2375 ----+-----+-----+----
2376 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2381--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002383The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2384limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2385they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2386limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002387marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002388option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002389and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2390with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2391specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002392
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002393
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002394 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2395------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2396acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002397backlog X X X -
2398balance X - X X
2399bind - X X -
2400bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002401block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402capture cookie - X X -
2403capture request header - X X -
2404capture response header - X X -
2405clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002406compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002407contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2408cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002409declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410default-server X - X X
2411default_backend X X X -
2412description - X X X
2413disabled X X X X
2414dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002415email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002416email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002417email-alert mailers X X X X
2418email-alert myhostname X X X X
2419email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002420enabled X X X X
2421errorfile X X X X
2422errorloc X X X X
2423errorloc302 X X X X
2424-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2425errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002426force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002427filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002428fullconn X - X X
2429grace X X X X
2430hash-type X - X X
2431http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002432http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002433http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002435http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002436http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002437http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002438id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002439ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002440load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002441log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002442log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002443log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002444log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002445max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002446maxconn X X X -
2447mode X X X X
2448monitor fail - X X -
2449monitor-net X X X -
2450monitor-uri X X X -
2451option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2452option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2453option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2454option allbackups (*) X - X X
2455option checkcache (*) X - X X
2456option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2457option contstats (*) X X X -
2458option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2459option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002460-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2461option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2463option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002464option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002465option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002466option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002467option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002468option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002470option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002471option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002472option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option httpchk X - X X
2474option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002475option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002477option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002478option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002479option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2481option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2482option logasap (*) X X X -
2483option mysql-check X - X X
2484option nolinger (*) X X X X
2485option originalto X X X X
2486option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002487option pgsql-check X - X X
2488option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002489option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002490option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option smtpchk X - X X
2492option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2493option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2494option splice-request (*) X X X X
2495option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002496option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002497option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2498option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2499-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002500option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002501option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2502option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2503option tcpka X X X X
2504option tcplog X X X X
2505option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002506external-check command X - X X
2507external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2509rate-limit sessions X X X -
2510redirect - X X X
2511redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2512redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002513reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2524reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002525-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002526reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002527retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002528retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002529rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2534rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2535rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002537server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002538server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539source X - X X
2540srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002541stats admin - X X X
2542stats auth X X X X
2543stats enable X X X X
2544stats hide-version X X X X
2545stats http-request - X X X
2546stats realm X X X X
2547stats refresh X X X X
2548stats scope X X X X
2549stats show-desc X X X X
2550stats show-legends X X X X
2551stats show-node X X X X
2552stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2554stick match - - X X
2555stick on - - X X
2556stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002557stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002558stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002559tcp-check connect - - X X
2560tcp-check expect - - X X
2561tcp-check send - - X X
2562tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002563tcp-request connection - X X -
2564tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002565tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002566tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002567tcp-response content - - X X
2568tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569timeout check X - X X
2570timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002571timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2573timeout connect X - X X
2574timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2575timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2576timeout http-request X X X X
2577timeout queue X - X X
2578timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002579timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2581timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002582timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002584unique-id-format X X X -
2585unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002587use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002588------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2589 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2593---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594
2595This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2596
2597
2598acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2599 Declare or complete an access list.
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 no | yes | yes | yes
2602 Example:
2603 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2604 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2605 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
2609
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002610backlog <conns>
2611 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2616 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002617 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002618
2619 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2620 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2621 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2622 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2623 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2624 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2625 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2626 backlog parameter.
2627
2628 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2629 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2630 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2631
2632 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2633
2634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002636balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2639 yes | no | yes | yes
2640 Arguments :
2641 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2642 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2643 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2644 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2645
2646 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2647 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2648 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2649 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002650 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002651 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002652 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2653 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2654 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2655 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2656 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2657 it, so that you don't worry.
2658
2659 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2660 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2661 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2662 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2663 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2664 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2665 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2666 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002668 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2669 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2670 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2671 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2672 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2673 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2674 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2675 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2676
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002677 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002678 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002679 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2680 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002681 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002682 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2683 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2684 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2685 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2686 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002687 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2688 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2689 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2690 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2691 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2692 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2695 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2696 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2697 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2698 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2699 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2700 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2701 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002704 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2705 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2706 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002708 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2709 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2710 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2711 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2712 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2713 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2714 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2715 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2716 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2717 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2718 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2719 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002721 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002722 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2723 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2724 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2725 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2726 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2727 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2728 URIs start with a leading "/".
2729
2730 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2731 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2732 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2733 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002736 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2737
2738 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002739 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2740 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002741 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2742 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2743 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2744 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002745 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002746 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2747 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002748
2749 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2750 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2751 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2752 server will receive the request.
2753
2754 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2755 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2756 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2757 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2758 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002759 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2760 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2761 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002763 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2764 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2765 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2766 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2767 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002769 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002770 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2771 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2772 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2773
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002774 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2775 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2776 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2777
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002778 random
2779 random(<draws>)
2780 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002781 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2782 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2783 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2784 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002785 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2786 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2787 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2788 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2789 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2790 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2791 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2792 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2793 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2794 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2795 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2796 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2797 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2798 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2799 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2800 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2801 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2802 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2803 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2804 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002805
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002806 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002807 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002808 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2809 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2810 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2811 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2812 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2813 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002814 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002815 used instead.
2816
2817 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2818 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2819 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2820 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2821
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002822 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2823 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2824 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2825
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002826 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002829 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2830 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002831
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002832 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2833 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2834 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002836 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002837 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002838 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2839 NTLM relies on.
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 Examples :
2842 balance roundrobin
2843 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002844 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002845 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2846 balance hdr(host)
2847 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002848
2849 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2850 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002853 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2854 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2855 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2856 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2857
2858 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2859 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2860 defaults to 16 kB.
2861
2862 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2863 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2864
2865 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2866 Round Robin.
2867
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002868 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002869 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2870 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2871 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2872
2873 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2874
2875 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002876 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002877 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2878 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2879 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002881 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
2883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002884bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2885bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 no | yes | yes | no
2889 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002890 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2891 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2892 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2893 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002894 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002895 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2896 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2897 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2898 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2899 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2900 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2901 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002902 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2903 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2904 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2905 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2906 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2907 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2908 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002909 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2910 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2911 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002912 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2913 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2914 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2915 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002916 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2917 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2918 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002919
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002920 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2921 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002922 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2923 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2924 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002925 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2926 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2927 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2928 the range.
2929
2930 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2931 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2932 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2933 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2934 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2935 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2936 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002938 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002940 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002941 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2943 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2944 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2945 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2946 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2947 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002949 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2950 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2951 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2952 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2955 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2956 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2957 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2958 in a frontend.
2959
2960 Example :
2961 listen http_proxy
2962 bind :80,:443
2963 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002964 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002966 listen http_https_proxy
2967 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002968 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002969
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002970 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2971 bind ipv6@:80
2972 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2973 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2974
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002975 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002976 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002977
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002978 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2979 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2980 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2981 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2982 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2983
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002984 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002985 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
2987
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002988bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2991 yes | yes | yes | yes
2992 Arguments :
2993 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2994 may be used to override a default value.
2995
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002996 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002997 option may be combined with other numbers.
2998
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002999 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003000 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3001 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3002 missing from all processes.
3003
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003004 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003005 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003006 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3007 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3008 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3009 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3010 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003011 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003012
3013 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3014 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3015 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3016 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3017 and 'even' instances.
3018
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003019 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3020 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3021 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3022 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003023
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003024 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3025 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3026
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003027 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3028 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3029 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3030
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003031 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3032 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3033
3034 Example :
3035 listen app_ip1
3036 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003037 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003038
3039 listen app_ip2
3040 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003041 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003042
3043 listen management
3044 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003045 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003046
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003047 listen management
3048 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3049 bind-process 1-4
3050
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003051 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003052
3053
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003054block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3057 no | yes | yes | yes
3058
3059 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3060 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003061 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003062 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003064 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3065 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3066 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003068 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3069 "http-request deny" instead.
3070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071 Example:
3072 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3073 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3074 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003075 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3076 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3077 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003079 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3080 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3081 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
3083capture cookie <name> len <length>
3084 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 no | yes | yes | no
3087 Arguments :
3088 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3089 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3090 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3091 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093
3094 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3095 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3096 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3097 right if it exceeds <length>.
3098
3099 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3100 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3101 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3102 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3103
3104 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3105 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3106 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3107
3108 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3109 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3110 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003111 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3112 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3113 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114
3115 Example:
3116 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3117
3118 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003119 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
3121
3122capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003123 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3125 no | yes | yes | no
3126 Arguments :
3127 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003128 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3130 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3131 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3132
3133 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3134 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3135 it exceeds <length>.
3136
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003137 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3139 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003140 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3141 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3142 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3143 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003144 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003145 environments to find where the request came from.
3146
3147 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3148 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3149 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3150 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003152 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3153 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3154 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3155 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3156 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
3158 Example:
3159 capture request header Host len 15
3160 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003161 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003163 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164 about logging.
3165
3166
3167capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003168 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 no | yes | yes | no
3171 Arguments :
3172 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003173 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3175 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3176 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3177
3178 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3179 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3180 it exceeds <length>.
3181
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003182 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3184 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3185 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003186 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3187 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3188 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3189 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003191 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3192 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3193 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3194 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3195 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
3197 Example:
3198 capture response header Content-length len 9
3199 capture response header Location len 15
3200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003201 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 about logging.
3203
3204
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003205clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3212 as explained at the top of this document.
3213
3214 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3215 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3216 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3217 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3218 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3219 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3220 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3221 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003222 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003223 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003224 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
3226 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3227 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3228 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3229 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3230 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3231 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3232
3233 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3234 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3235
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003236 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3237 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003239compression algo <algorithm> ...
3240compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003241compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003242 Enable HTTP compression.
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | yes
3245 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003246 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3247 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3248 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3249
3250 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003251 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3252 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3253 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003254
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003255 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003256 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003257
3258 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3259 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3260 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3261 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3262 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003263 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003264
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003265 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3266 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3267 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3268 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3269 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3270 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3271 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003272 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003273
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003274 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003276 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3277 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3278 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3279 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3280 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003281
3282 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3283 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3284 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3285 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3286 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003287 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3288 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3289 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3290 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3291 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003292 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3293 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003294
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003295 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003296 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3297 "Accept-Encoding" header
3298 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003299 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003300 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3301 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3302 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3303 "multipart"
3304 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3305 header
3306 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3307 and later
3308 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3309 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003310 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003311
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003312 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003313
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003314 Examples :
3315 compression algo gzip
3316 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003318
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003319contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 yes | no | yes | yes
3323 Arguments :
3324 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3326 as explained at the top of this document.
3327
3328 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003329 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003330 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3333 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3334 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3335
3336 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3337 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3338 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3339 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3340 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3341 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3342
3343 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3344 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3345 instead.
3346
3347 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3348 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3349
3350
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003351cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003352 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3353 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003354 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 yes | no | yes | yes
3358 Arguments :
3359 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3360 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3361 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3362 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3363 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3364 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003365 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3367 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3368
3369 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3370 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3371 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3372 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3373 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3374 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003375 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3376 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003377 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003378 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3379 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
3381 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003382 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003383
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003384 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003385 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003386 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003387 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003388 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3389 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3390 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3391 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3392 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3393 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3394 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
3396 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3397 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3398 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3399 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3400 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3401 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3402 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3403 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3404 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003405 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3407 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3408 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003410 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3411 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3412 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003413 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3414 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3415 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3416 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003417 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3418 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3419 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
3421 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3422 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3423 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3424 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3425 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3426 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3427 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3428 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3429 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3430
3431 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3432 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3433 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3434 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3435 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3436 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3437 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3438 persistence cookie in the cache.
3439 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3440
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3442 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3443 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3444 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3445 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003447 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3448 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3449 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3450 they logout.
3451
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003452 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3453 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3454 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3455 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3456
3457 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3458 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3459 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3460 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3461 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3462 this attribute.
3463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003464 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003465 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003466 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3467 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3468 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3469 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3470 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3471 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003472
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003473 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3474 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3475 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3476 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3477 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3478 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3479 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3480 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003482 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3483 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3484 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3485 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3486 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3487 the site.
3488
3489 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3490 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3491 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3492 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3493 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3494 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3495 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3496 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3497 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3498 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3499 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3500 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3501 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003503 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3504 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3505
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003506 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3507 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3508 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3509 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3510 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3511 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3512
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003513 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3514 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3515 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3516 repeated.
3517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3519 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3520 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3521 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523 Examples :
3524 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3525 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3526 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003527 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003529 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003531
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003532declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3533 Declares a capture slot.
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 no | yes | yes | no
3536 Arguments:
3537 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3538
3539 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3540 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3541 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3542 for use in the response.
3543
3544 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003545 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3547
3548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003549default-server [param*]
3550 Change default options for a server in a backend
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | no | yes | yes
3553 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003554 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3555 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3556 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3557 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003558
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003559 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003560 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3561
3562 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565default_backend <backend>
3566 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | no
3569 Arguments :
3570 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3571
3572 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3573 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3574 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3575 will catch all undetermined requests.
3576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003577 Example :
3578
3579 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3580 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3581 default_backend dynamic
3582
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003583 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003586description <string>
3587 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 no | yes | yes | yes
3590 Arguments : string
3591
3592 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3593 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3594 it describes.
3595 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3596
3597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598disabled
3599 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | yes
3602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3605 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3606 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3607 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3608 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3609 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3610 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3611
3612 See also : "enabled"
3613
3614
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003615dispatch <address>:<port>
3616 Set a default server address
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003620
3621 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3622 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3623 during start-up.
3624
3625 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3626 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3627 possible with normal servers.
3628
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003629 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003630 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3631 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3632 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3633 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3634
3635 See also : "server"
3636
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003637
3638dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3639 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3641 yes | no | yes | yes
3642 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3643
3644 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003645 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003646 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3647 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003648 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003649 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003651enabled
3652 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | yes | yes | yes
3655 Arguments : none
3656
3657 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3658 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3659
3660 See also : "disabled"
3661
3662
3663errorfile <code> <file>
3664 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | yes | yes | yes
3667 Arguments :
3668 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003669 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3670 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
3672 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003673 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003675 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3676 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003677
3678 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3679 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3680 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3681
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003682 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3685 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3686 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3687 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3688
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003689 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3690 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003691 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003692 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3693 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3694 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3697 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3698 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003699 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3701
3702 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3703
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003704 Example :
3705 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003706 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003707 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3708 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003710
3711errorloc <code> <url>
3712errorloc302 <code> <url>
3713 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | yes
3716 Arguments :
3717 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003718 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3719 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003720
3721 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3722 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3723 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3724 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003725 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003726
3727 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3728 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3729 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3730
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003731 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003733 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3734 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3735 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3736 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003737 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3739 request.
3740
3741 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3742
3743
3744errorloc303 <code> <url>
3745 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | yes
3748 Arguments :
3749 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003750 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3751 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003752
3753 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3754 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3755 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3756 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003757 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003758
3759 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3760 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3761 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3762
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003763 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003765 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3766 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3767 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3768 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003769 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770
3771 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3772
3773
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003774email-alert from <emailaddr>
3775 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003776 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | yes | yes | yes
3779
3780 Arguments :
3781
3782 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3783
3784 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3785 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3786
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003787 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003788 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3789 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003790
3791
3792email-alert level <level>
3793 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3794 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 yes | yes | yes | yes
3797
3798 Arguments :
3799
3800 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3801 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3802 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3803
3804 By default level is alert
3805
3806 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3807 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3808 for the proxy.
3809
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003810 Alerts are sent when :
3811
3812 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3813 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3814 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3815 is notice or lower
3816 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3817 and a health check status update occurs
3818
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003819 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3820 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003821 section 3.6 about mailers.
3822
3823
3824email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3825 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | yes | yes | yes
3828
3829 Arguments :
3830
3831 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3832
3833 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3834 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3835
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003836 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3837 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003838
3839
3840email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3841 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3842 mailers.
3843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 yes | yes | yes | yes
3845
3846 Arguments :
3847
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003848 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003849
3850 By default the systems hostname is used.
3851
3852 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3853 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3854 for the proxy.
3855
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003856 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3857 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003858
3859
3860email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003861 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003862 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3864 yes | yes | yes | yes
3865
3866 Arguments :
3867
3868 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3869
3870 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3871 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3872
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003873 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003874 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3875
3876
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003877force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3878 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003880 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003881
3882 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3883 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3884 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3885 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3886 marked down for maintenance operations.
3887
3888 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3889 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3890 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3891 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3892 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3893 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3894 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3895 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3896 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3897
3898 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3899 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3900 is used.
3901
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003902 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003903 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003904
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003905
3906filter <name> [param*]
3907 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3909 no | yes | yes | yes
3910 Arguments :
3911 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3912 referenced in section 9.
3913
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003914 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003915 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003916 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3917 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003918
3919 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3920 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3921
3922 Example:
3923 listen
3924 bind *:80
3925
3926 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3927 filter compression
3928 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3929
3930 compression algo gzip
3931 compression offload
3932
3933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3934
3935 See also : section 9.
3936
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003938fullconn <conns>
3939 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | no | yes | yes
3942 Arguments :
3943 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3944 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3945
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003946 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003947 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003948 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003949 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3950 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3951 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3952 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3953 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003954 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003955
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003956 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3957 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003958 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3959 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3960 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003962 Example :
3963 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3964 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3965 # connections.
3966 backend dynamic
3967 fullconn 10000
3968 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3970
3971 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3972
3973
3974grace <time>
3975 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003977 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003978 Arguments :
3979 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3980 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3981 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3982
3983 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3984 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003985 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003986 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3987
3988 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3989 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3990 simplify it.
3991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003992
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003993hash-balance-factor <factor>
3994 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | no | no | yes
3997 Arguments :
3998 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3999 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004000 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004001
4002 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4003 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4004 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4005 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4006 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4007 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4008 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4009
4010 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4011 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4012 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4013 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4014 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4015
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004016 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4017 consistent hashing mechanism.
4018
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004019 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4020
4021
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004022hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004023 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004027 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4028 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004029
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004030 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4031 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4032 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4033 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4034 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4035 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4036 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4037 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4038 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4039 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004040
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004041 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4042 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4043 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4044 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4045 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4046 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4047 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4048 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4049 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4050 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4051 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4052 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4053 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004054 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4055 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004056
4057 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4058
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004059 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004060 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4061 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4062 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004063 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4064 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4065 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004066
4067 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4068 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004069 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4070 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4071 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4072 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4073
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004074 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4075 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4076 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4077 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4078 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4079 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4080 parameter.
4081
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004082 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4083 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4084 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4085 used on strings.
4086
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004087 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4088
4089 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4090 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4091 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4092 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4093 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4094 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4095 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4096 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4097 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4098 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4099 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4100 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004101
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004102 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4103 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4104 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004105
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004106 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107
4108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109http-check disable-on-404
4110 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4116 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4117 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4118 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4119 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4120 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4121 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4122 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004123 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4124 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4125 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4126
4127 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4128
4129
4130http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004131 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004133 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 Arguments :
4135 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4136 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004137 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004138 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4139 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4140 details on the supported keywords.
4141
4142 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4143 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4144 with the usual backslash ('\').
4145
4146 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4147 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4148 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4149 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4150 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4151
4152 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004153 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004154 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4155 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4156 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4157
4158 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004159 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004160 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4161 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4162 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4163 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4164
4165 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004166 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004167 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4168 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4169 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4170 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4171 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004172 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004173 trace).
4174
4175 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004176 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004177 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4178 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4179 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4180 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4181 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004182 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004183
4184 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4185 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4186 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4187 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4188 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4189 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4190 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4191 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4192
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004193 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4194 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4195 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4196
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004197 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4198 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4199
4200 Examples :
4201 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004202 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004203
4204 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004205 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004206
4207 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004208 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004209
4210 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004211 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004213 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214
4215
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004216http-check send-state
4217 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | no | yes | yes
4220 Arguments : none
4221
4222 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4223 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4224 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4225 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4226 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4227
4228 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4229 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4230 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4231 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4232 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004233 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4234 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4235 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4236
4237 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4238 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4239 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4240
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004241 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4242 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4243 checked in multiple backends.
4244
4245 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4246 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4247
4248 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4249 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4250 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4251 one fails.
4252
4253 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4254 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4255 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4256
4257 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4258 server's queue.
4259
4260 Example of a header received by the application server :
4261 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4262 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4263
4264 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004266
4267http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004268 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4269
4270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 no | yes | yes | yes
4272
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004273 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4274 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4275 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4276 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4277 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4280 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4285 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4286 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4287 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4290 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4291 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4292 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 Example:
4295 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4296 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4297 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 http-request allow if nagios
4300 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4301 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4302 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304 Example:
4305 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4306 acl add path /addacl
4307 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4312 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004314 Example:
4315 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4316 acl setmap path /setmap
4317 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004319 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4322 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4325 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4330 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4331 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4332 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4333 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4334 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4335 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4336 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4341 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4342 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4343 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4344 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4345 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4346 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4347 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004349http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4352 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004353
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4358 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4359 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4360 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4361 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004363 Example:
4364 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4365 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004366
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004367http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4375 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4376 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4377 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4378 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4379 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4380 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4381 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4382 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4385 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4386 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4387 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4388 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4389 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004391http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004393 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4394 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4395 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4396 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4397 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4398 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004402 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4407 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4408 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4409 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4410 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4411 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004413http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4416 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4417 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4418 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4419 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004420
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004421http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4422 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4423 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4424 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4425
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004426http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4427
4428 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4429 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4430 pointed by <resolvers>.
4431 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4432 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4433 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4434 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4435 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4436 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4437 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4438 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4439 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4440 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4441 to 0.0.0.0.
4442
4443 Example:
4444 resolvers mydns
4445 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4446 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4447 timeout retry 1s
4448 hold valid 10s
4449 hold nx 3s
4450 hold other 3s
4451 hold obsolete 0s
4452 accepted_payload_size 8192
4453
4454 frontend fe
4455 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4456 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4457 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4458
4459 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4460 # which mean DNS resolution error
4461 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4462
4463 default_backend be
4464
4465 backend b_503
4466 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4467 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4468 # 503 error page to end users
4469
4470 backend be
4471 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4472 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4473 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4474 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4475 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4476
4477 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4478 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4479
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004480http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4481
4482 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4483 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4484 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4485 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004486 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4487 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004488
4489 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004491http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004493 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4494 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4495 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4496 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4497 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004499http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4502 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4503 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4504 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004506http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4507 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004508
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004509 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4510 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4511 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4512 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4513 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4514 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004515
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004516 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4517 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4518 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4519 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4520 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004521
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004522 Example:
4523 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4524
4525 # applied to:
4526 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4527
4528 # outputs:
4529 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4530
4531 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004532
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004533 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4534
4535 # applied to:
4536 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004537
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004538 # outputs:
4539 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004540
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004541http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4542 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4543
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004544 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4545 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4546 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4547 against.
4548
4549 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4550 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4551 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004552
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004553 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4554 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4555 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4556 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4557 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4558 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4559 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4560 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4561 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
4562 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004563
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004564 Example:
4565 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4566 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004567
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004568 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4569 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4572 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004573
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004574 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4575 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4576 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4577 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004578
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004579 Example:
4580 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004581
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004582 # applied to:
4583 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004584
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004585 # outputs:
4586 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004588http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4589http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004591 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4592 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4593 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004595http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004597 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4598 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4599 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004601http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004603 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4604 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4605 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4606 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4607 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609 Arguments:
4610 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4611 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004613 Example:
4614 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4615 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4618 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004620http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004622 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4623 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4624 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004626 Arguments:
4627 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4628 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004630 Example:
4631 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4632 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004634 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4635 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4636 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004638http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004640 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4641 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4642 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4643 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4644 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646 Example:
4647 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4648 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4649 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4650 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4651 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4652 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4653 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4654 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4655 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004657http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004659 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4660 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4661 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4662 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4663 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4666 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4669 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4670 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4671 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4672 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4673 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4674 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4675 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4676 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004678http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004680 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4681 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4682 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4683 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4684 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4685 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4686 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004688http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004690 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4691 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4692 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004694http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004696 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4697 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4698 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4699 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4700 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4701 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4702 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4703 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004705http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004707 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4708 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4709 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4710 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4711 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4712 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004714 Example :
4715 # prepend the host name before the path
4716 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004718http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004720 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4721 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4722 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4723 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4724 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004726http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004727
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004728 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4729 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4730 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4731 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4732 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4733 values have higher priority.
4734 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4735 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4736 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4737 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4738 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004740http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004742 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4743 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4744 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4745 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4746 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4747 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4748 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004750 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004751
4752 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004753 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4754 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004756http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4757 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4758 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4759 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4760 privacy.
4761
4762 Arguments :
4763 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4764 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004765
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004766 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4768 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4769
4770 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4771 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4772
4773http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4774
4775 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4776 expression.
4777
4778 Arguments:
4779 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4780 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004781
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004782 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004783 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4784 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4785
4786 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4787 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4788 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4789
4790http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4791
4792 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4793 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4794 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4795 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4796 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4797 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4798 information from the request.
4799
4800 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4801
4802http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4803
4804 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4805 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4806 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4807 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4808 path and the query string.
4809 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4810
4811http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4812
4813 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4814 inline.
4815
4816 Arguments:
4817 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4818 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4819 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4820 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4821 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4822 (request and response)
4823 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4824 processing
4825 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4826 processing
4827 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4828 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4829 and '_'.
4830
4831 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4832 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004833
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004834 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004835 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004837http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4838 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004840 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4841 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4842 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4843 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4844 agent name must be used.
4845
4846 Arguments:
4847 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4848
4849 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4850 configuration.
4851
4852http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4853
4854 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4855 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4856 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4857 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4858 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4859 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4860 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4861 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4862 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4863 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4864 action.
4865 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4866 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4867 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4868 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4869 you fully understand how it works.
4870
4871http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4872
4873 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4874 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4875 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4876 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4877 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4878 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4879 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4880 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4881 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4882 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4883 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4884 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4885 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4886
4887http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4888http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4889http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4890
4891 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4892 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4893 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4894 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4895 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4896 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4897 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4898 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4899 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4900 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4901 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4902 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4903
4904 Arguments :
4905 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4906 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4907 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4908 select which table entry to update the counters.
4909
4910 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4911 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4912 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4913 that table until the session ends.
4914
4915 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4916 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4917 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4918 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4919 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4920 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4921 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4922 useful information.
4923
4924 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4925 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4926 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4927 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4928 checks that make use of it.
4929
4930http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4931
4932 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004933
4934 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004935 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004936
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004937http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4938
4939 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4940 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4941 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4942 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4943 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4944 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4945
4946 Arguments :
4947 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4948
4949 Example:
4950 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004952http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004953
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004954 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4955 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4956 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004957
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004959http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004960 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4961
4962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 no | yes | yes | yes
4964
4965 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4966 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4967 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4968 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4969 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4970 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4973 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004975 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004977 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4978 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4979 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4980 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4983 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4984 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4985 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004987 Example:
4988 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004990 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004991
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004992 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4993 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004995 Example:
4996 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004998 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005000 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5001 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5004 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005006http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005008 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5009 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5010 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5011 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5012 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5013 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5014 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5015 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005017http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5020 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5021 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5022 example, or to pass some internal information.
5023 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5024 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5025 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005027http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5030 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005031
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005032http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005038 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5039 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5040 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5041 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5042 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5043 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5044 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005046 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5047 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5048 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5049 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5050 keyword.
5051 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
5052 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005056 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5057 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5058 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5059 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5060 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5061 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005063http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005069 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5070 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5071 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5072 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5073 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5074 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005076http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5079 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005081http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005083 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5084 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5085 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5086 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5087 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5088 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005090http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5091 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005092
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005093 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5094 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005096 Example:
5097 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005099 # applied to:
5100 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005102 # outputs:
5103 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005107http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5108 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005109
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005110 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5111 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005113 Example:
5114 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116 # applied to:
5117 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005119 # outputs:
5120 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005122http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5123http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005125 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5126 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5127 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005129http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005131 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5132 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5133 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005135http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005137 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5138 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5139 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5140 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5141 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143 Arguments:
5144 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005146 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5147 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005148
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005149http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005150
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005151 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5152 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5153 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005155http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5156
5157 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5158 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5159 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5160 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5161 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5162
5163http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5164
5165 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5166 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5167 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5168 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5169 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5170 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5171 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5172 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5173 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5174
5175http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5176
5177 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5178 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5179 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5180 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5181 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5182 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5183 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5184
5185http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5186
5187 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5188 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5189 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5190 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5191 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5192 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5193 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5194 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5195
5196http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5198
5199 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5200 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5201 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5202 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005203
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005204 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005205 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5206 http-response set-status 431
5207 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5208 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005210http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005212 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5213 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5214 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5215 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5216 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5217 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5218 based on some information from the request.
5219
5220 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5221
5222http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5223
5224 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5225 inline.
5226
5227 Arguments:
5228 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5229 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5230 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5231 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5232 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5233 (request and response)
5234 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5235 processing
5236 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5237 processing
5238 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5239 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5240 and '_'.
5241
5242 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5243 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005244
5245 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005246 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005248http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005249
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005250 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5251 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5252 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5253 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5254 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5255 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5256 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5257 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5258 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5259 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5260 action.
5261 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5262 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5263 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5264 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5265 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005266
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005267http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5268http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5269http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005270
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005271 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5272 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5273 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5274 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5275 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5276 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5277
5278http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5279
5280 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5281 about <var-name>.
5282
5283 Example:
5284 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5285
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005286
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005287http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5288 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5289
5290 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5291 yes | no | yes | yes
5292
5293 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005294 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5295 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5296 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005297
5298 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5299
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005300 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5301 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5302 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5303 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5304 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5305 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5306 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5307 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5308 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5309 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005310
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005311 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5312 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5313 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5314 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5315 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5316 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5317 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5318 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005319
5320 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5321 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5322 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5323 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5324 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5325 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5326 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5327 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005328 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005329 downsides of rare connection failures.
5330
5331 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5332 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5333 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5334 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5335 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5336 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005337 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005338 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5339 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5340 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5341 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5342 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5343
5344 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005345 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5346 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5347 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005348
5349 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005350 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005351
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005352 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5353 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005354
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005355 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005356
5357 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5358 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5359 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5360
5361 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5362
5363
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005364http-send-name-header [<header>]
5365 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005366 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5367 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005368 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005369 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5370
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005371 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5372 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5373 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5374 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5375 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5376 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5377 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5378 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5379 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5380 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5381 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5382 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5383 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5384 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5385 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5386 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005387
5388 See also : "server"
5389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005390id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005391 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5393 no | yes | yes | yes
5394 Arguments : none
5395
5396 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5397 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5398 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005399
5400
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005401ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5402 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005404 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005405
5406 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5407 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5408 and running).
5409
5410 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5411 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5412 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005413 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005414 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5415
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005416 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5417 "unless" condition is met.
5418
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005419 Example:
5420 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5421 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5422 ignore-persist if url_static
5423
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005424 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5425
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005426load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5427 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | no | yes | yes
5430
5431 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5432 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5433 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005434 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005435 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5436 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5437 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5438 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5439
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005440 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005441 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005442 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005443
5444 Arguments:
5445 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5446 named "server-state-file".
5447
5448 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5449 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5450 name is used as a file name.
5451
5452 none don't load any stat for this backend
5453
5454 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005455 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5456 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5457 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005458 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005459 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005460
5461 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5462 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5463
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005464 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005465
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005466 global
5467 stats socket /tmp/socket
5468 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005469
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005470 defaults
5471 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005472
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005473 backend bk
5474 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5475 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005476
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005477
5478 Then one can run :
5479
5480 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5481
5482 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5483
5484 1
5485 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5486 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5487 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5488
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005489 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005490
5491 global
5492 stats socket /tmp/socket
5493 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5494
5495 defaults
5496 load-server-state-from-file local
5497
5498 backend bk
5499 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5500 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5501
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005502
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005503 Then one can run :
5504
5505 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5506
5507 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5508
5509 1
5510 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5511 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5512 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5513
5514 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5515 "show servers state"
5516
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005517
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005518log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005519log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5520 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005521no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005522 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5524 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005525
5526 Prefix :
5527 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5528 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5529 prefix does not allow arguments.
5530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005531 Arguments :
5532 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5533 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5534 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5535 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5536 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5537 parameter.
5538
5539 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5540 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5541
5542 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5543 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5544 standard syslog port).
5545
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005546 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5547 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5548 standard syslog port).
5549
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005550 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5551 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5552 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005553 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005554
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005555 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5556 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5557 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5558 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5559 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5560 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5561 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5562 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5563 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5564 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5565 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5566 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5567 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5568 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5569 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5570 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005571 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5572 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005573
5574 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5575 and "fd@2", see above.
5576
5577 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5578 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005579
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005580 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5581 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5582 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5583 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5584 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5585 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5586 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5587 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5588 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5589 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005590 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005591
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005592 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5593 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5594 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5595 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5596 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5597
5598 <sample_size>
5599 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5600 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5601 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5602 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5603 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5604
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005605 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5606 one of the following :
5607
5608 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5609 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5610
5611 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5612 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5613
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005614 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5615 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5616 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5617 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5618 systemd logger consumes.
5619
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005620 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5621 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5622 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5623 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5624
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005625 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5626
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005627 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5628 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5629 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5630
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005631 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5632 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5633 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5634 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005635
5636 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5637 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5638 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005639 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5640 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5641 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5642 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5643 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005644
5645 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5646
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005647 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5648 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5649 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005650
5651 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5652 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5653 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5654 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5655
5656 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5657 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005658
5659 Example :
5660 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005661 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5662 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5663 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005664 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5665 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005666 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005667
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005668
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005669log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005670 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5671 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5672 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005673
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005674 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5675 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5676 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5677 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5678 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005679
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005680 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5681 "option httplog" directives.
5682
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005683log-format-sd <string>
5684 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5685 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5686 yes | yes | yes | no
5687
5688 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5689 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5690 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5691 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5692 which covers the log format string in depth.
5693
5694 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5695 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5696
5697 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5698 log format to "rfc5424".
5699
5700 Example :
5701 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5702
5703
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005704log-tag <string>
5705 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5706 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5707 yes | yes | yes | yes
5708
5709 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5710 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5711 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5712 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5713 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5714 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5715 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5716 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5717 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005718
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005719max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5720 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5722 yes | no | yes | yes
5723
5724 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5725 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5726 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5727 servers.
5728
5729 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5730 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5731 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5732 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5733 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005734 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005735 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5736 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5737 picking a different server.
5738
5739 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5740 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5741 even if they have to be queued.
5742
5743 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5744 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5745
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005746max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5747 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5748 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5749 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005750
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005751maxconn <conns>
5752 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5754 yes | yes | yes | no
5755 Arguments :
5756 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5757 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5758 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5759 closes.
5760
5761 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5762 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5763 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5764 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005765 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5766 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5767 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5768 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005769
5770 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5771 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5772 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5773
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005774 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5775 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005776
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005777 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5778
5779
5780mode { tcp|http|health }
5781 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5783 yes | yes | yes | yes
5784 Arguments :
5785 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5786 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5787 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5788 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5789
5790 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5791 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5792 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5793 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5794 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5795
5796 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005797 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5798 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5799 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5800 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5801 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5802 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5803 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005804
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005805 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5806 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5807 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005808
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005809 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005810 defaults http_instances
5811 mode http
5812
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005813 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005814
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005815
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005816monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005817 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5819 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005820 Arguments :
5821 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5822 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005823 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005824 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5825 backend and its backup.
5826
5827 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5828 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5829 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5830 servers in a list of backends.
5831
5832 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5833 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5834 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5835 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5836 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5837 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5838 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005839 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5840 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005841
5842 Example:
5843 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005844 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005845 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5846 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5847 monitor-uri /site_alive
5848 monitor fail if site_dead
5849
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005850 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005851
5852
5853monitor-net <source>
5854 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5856 yes | yes | yes | no
5857 Arguments :
5858 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5859 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5860 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5861 followed by a mask.
5862
5863 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5864 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005865 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005866 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5867
5868 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5869 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5870 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5871 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005872 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5873 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5874 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005875
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005876 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5877 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5878 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5879 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5880 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5881 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005882
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005883 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5884 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005885
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005886 Example :
5887 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5888 frontend www
5889 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5890
5891 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5892
5893
5894monitor-uri <uri>
5895 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5897 yes | yes | yes | no
5898 Arguments :
5899 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5900 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5901
5902 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5903 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5904 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5905 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5906 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5907 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5908 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5909 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5910
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005911 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5912 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5913 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5914 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5915 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5916 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5917 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5918 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005919
5920 Example :
5921 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5922 frontend www
5923 mode http
5924 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5925
5926 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005928
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005929option abortonclose
5930no option abortonclose
5931 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5933 yes | no | yes | yes
5934 Arguments : none
5935
5936 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5937 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5938 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5939 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005940 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005941 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5942 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5943 encountered while delivering the response.
5944
5945 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5946 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5947 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5948 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5949 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5950 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005951 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005952 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005953 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005954 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5955 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5956 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5957
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005958 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5959 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005960 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5961 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5962 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5963 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5964 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5965 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005966 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005967
5968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5970
5971 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5972
5973
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005974option accept-invalid-http-request
5975no option accept-invalid-http-request
5976 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5978 yes | yes | yes | no
5979 Arguments : none
5980
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005981 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005982 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005983 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005984 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5985 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5986 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5987 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5988 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005989 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5990 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5991 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5992 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005993 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005994 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005995 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5996 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5997 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005998
5999 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6000 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6001 been confirmed.
6002
6003 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6004 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006005 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6006 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006007 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6008
6009 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6010 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6011
6012 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6013 stats socket.
6014
6015
6016option accept-invalid-http-response
6017no option accept-invalid-http-response
6018 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6020 yes | no | yes | yes
6021 Arguments : none
6022
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006023 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006024 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006025 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006026 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6027 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6028 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6029 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6030 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006031 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6032 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6033 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006034
6035 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6036 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6037 been confirmed.
6038
6039 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6040 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6041 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6042 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6043
6044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6046
6047 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6048 stats socket.
6049
6050
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006051option allbackups
6052no option allbackups
6053 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6055 yes | no | yes | yes
6056 Arguments : none
6057
6058 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6059 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6060 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6061 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6062 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6063 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6064 order between the backup servers anymore.
6065
6066 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6067 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6068
6069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6071
6072
6073option checkcache
6074no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006075 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6077 yes | no | yes | yes
6078 Arguments : none
6079
6080 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6081 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006082 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006083 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6084 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006085 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006086
6087 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006088 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006089 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006090 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6091 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006092 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006093 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006094 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6095 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006096 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006097 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6098 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006099 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006100 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6101 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6102 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6103 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6104 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6105 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6106 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6107 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6108 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6109
6110 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006111 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006112 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006113 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006114 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6115
6116 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6117 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006118 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006119 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006120
6121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6123
6124
6125option clitcpka
6126no option clitcpka
6127 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6129 yes | yes | yes | no
6130 Arguments : none
6131
6132 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6133 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006134 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006135 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6136
6137 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6138 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6139 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6140 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6141
6142 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6143 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6144 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6145 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6146 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6147
6148 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6149
6150 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6151 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6152 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6153
6154 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6155 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6156
6157 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6158
6159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006160option contstats
6161 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6163 yes | yes | yes | no
6164 Arguments : none
6165
6166 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6167 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6168 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6169 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006170 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6171 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6172 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6173 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6174 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006175
6176
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006177option dontlog-normal
6178no option dontlog-normal
6179 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6181 yes | yes | yes | no
6182 Arguments : none
6183
6184 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6185 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6186 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6187 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6188 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6189 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6190 logged.
6191
6192 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6193 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6194 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006196 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006197 logging.
6198
6199
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006200option dontlognull
6201no option dontlognull
6202 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6204 yes | yes | yes | no
6205 Arguments : none
6206
6207 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6208 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6209 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6210 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6211 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6212 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006213 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6214 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6215 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006216
6217 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006218 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006219 would not be logged.
6220
6221 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6222 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6223
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006224 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6225 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006226
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006227
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006228option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006229 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6231 yes | yes | yes | yes
6232 Arguments :
6233 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6234 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006235 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006236 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006237
6238 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6239 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6240 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6241 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6242 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6243 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6244 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006245 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6246 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6247 possible that the client has already brought one.
6248
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006249 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006250 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006251 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006252 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006253 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006254 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006255
6256 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6257 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6258 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6259 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6260 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6261 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6262 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6263
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006264 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6265 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6266 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6267 are under the control of the end-user.
6268
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006269 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006270 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6271 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006272 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6273 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6274 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006275
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006276 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006277 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6278 frontend www
6279 mode http
6280 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6281
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006282 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6283 backend www
6284 mode http
6285 option forwardfor header X-Client
6286
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006287 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006288 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006289
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006290
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006291option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6292no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6293 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6295 yes | yes | yes | no
6296 Arguments : none
6297
6298 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6299 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6300 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6301 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6302 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6303 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6304 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6305
6306 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6307 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6308 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6309 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6310 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6311 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6312 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6313 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6314 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6315 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6316
6317 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6318
6319 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6320 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6321
6322 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6323 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6324
6325
6326option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6327no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6328 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6330 yes | no | yes | yes
6331 Arguments : none
6332
6333 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6334 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6335 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6336 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6337 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6338 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6339 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6340
6341 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6342 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6343 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6344 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6345 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6346 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6347 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6348 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6349 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6350 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6351
6352 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6353
6354 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6355 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6356
6357 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6358 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6359
6360
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006361option http-buffer-request
6362no option http-buffer-request
6363 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6365 yes | yes | yes | yes
6366 Arguments : none
6367
6368 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6369 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6370 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6371 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6372 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6373 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6374 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6375 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006376 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006377 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6378 default.
6379
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006380 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006381
6382
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006383option http-ignore-probes
6384no option http-ignore-probes
6385 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6387 yes | yes | yes | no
6388 Arguments : none
6389
6390 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6391 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6392 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6393 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6394 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6395 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6396 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6397 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6398 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006399 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6400 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006401 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6402
6403 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6404 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6405 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6406 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6407 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6408 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6409 are often the only way to detect them.
6410
6411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6413
6414 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6415
6416
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006417option http-keep-alive
6418no option http-keep-alive
6419 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6421 yes | yes | yes | yes
6422 Arguments : none
6423
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006424 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6425 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006426 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6427 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6428 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6429 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6430 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006431
6432 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6433 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006434 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6435 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6436 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6437 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6438 situations where this option may be useful :
6439
6440 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006441 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006442
6443 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6444 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6445
6446 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6447 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6448 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6449 request.
6450
6451 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6452 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006453 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6454 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6455 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006456
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006457 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6458 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6459 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6460 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6461 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6462 not set.
6463
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006464 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006465 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6466 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006467
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006468 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006469 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006470 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006471
6472
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006473option http-no-delay
6474no option http-no-delay
6475 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6477 yes | yes | yes | yes
6478 Arguments : none
6479
6480 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6481 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6482 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6483 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6484 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6485 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6486 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6487 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6488 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6489 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6490 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6491 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6492 affected.
6493
6494 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6495 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6496 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6497 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6498 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6499 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6500 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6501 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6502 latency environments.
6503
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006504 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6505
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006506
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006507option http-pretend-keepalive
6508no option http-pretend-keepalive
6509 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006511 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006512 Arguments : none
6513
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006514 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006515 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6516 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6517 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6518 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6519 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6520 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6521 consider the response complete.
6522
6523 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6524 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6525 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6526 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006527 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006528 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6529
6530 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6531 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6532 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6533 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6534 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6535 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6536 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6537
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006538 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6539 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6540 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6541 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6542 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6543 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006544
6545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6547
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006548 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006549 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006550
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006551
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006552option http-server-close
6553no option http-server-close
6554 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6556 yes | yes | yes | yes
6557 Arguments : none
6558
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006559 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6560 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6561 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6562 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006563 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6564 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6565 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6566 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6567 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6568 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6569 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6570 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6571 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6572 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6573 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006574
6575 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6576 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6577 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6578 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006579 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6580 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006581
6582 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6583 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006584 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6585 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6586 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006587
6588 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6589 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6590
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006591 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6592 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006593
6594
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006595option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6596no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6597 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006599 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006600 Arguments : none
6601
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006602 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6603 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6604 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6605
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006606 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6607 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6608 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6609 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006610 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006611
6612 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006613 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006614 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6615 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6616 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6617 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6618 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6619 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6620 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006621
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006622 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6623 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6624 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6625 backend.
6626
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006627 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6628 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6629
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006630 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6631 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006632
6633
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006634option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006635no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006636 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6638 yes | yes | yes | no
6639 Arguments : none
6640
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006641 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006642 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6643 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6644 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6645 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6646 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6647 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6648
6649 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6650 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006651 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6652 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6653 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006654
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006655 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6656 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6657 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6658 front of an existing proxy.
6659
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006660 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6661
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006662 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006663
6664
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006665option http-use-htx
6666no option http-use-htx
6667 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6669 yes | yes | yes | yes
6670 Arguments : none
6671
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006672 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006673 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006674 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6675 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6676 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6677 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6678 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006679
6680 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6681 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6682 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6683 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006684 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6685 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6686 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6687 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006688
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006689 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6690 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6691 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6692 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6693 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006694
6695 See also : "mode http"
6696
6697
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006698option httpchk
6699option httpchk <uri>
6700option httpchk <method> <uri>
6701option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6702 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6704 yes | no | yes | yes
6705 Arguments :
6706 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6707 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6708 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6709 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6710 ones.
6711
6712 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6713 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6714 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6715
6716 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6717 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6718 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6719 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6720 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6721
6722 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6723 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6724 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6725 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6726 the lack of any response.
6727
6728 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6729
6730 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6731 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6732 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6733
6734 Examples :
6735 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6736 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6737 backend https_relay
6738 mode tcp
6739 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6740 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6741
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006742 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6743 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6744 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006745
6746
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006747option httpclose
6748no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006749 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6751 yes | yes | yes | yes
6752 Arguments : none
6753
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006754 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6755 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6756 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6757 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006758 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006759
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006760 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6761 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006762 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006763 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6764 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006765
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006766 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6767 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6768 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006769
6770 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6771 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006772 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006773 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6774 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6775 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006776
6777 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6778 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6779
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006780 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006781
6782
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006783option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006784 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006786 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006787 Arguments :
6788 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6789 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6790 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006791 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006792 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006793
6794 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6795 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6796 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6797 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6798 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6799 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6800 ports.
6801
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006802 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6803 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006804
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006805 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006807 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006808
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006809
6810option http_proxy
6811no option http_proxy
6812 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6814 yes | yes | yes | yes
6815 Arguments : none
6816
6817 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6818 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6819 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6820 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6821 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6822
6823 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6824 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006825 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6826 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006827
6828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6830
6831 Example :
6832 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6833 backend direct_forward
6834 option httpclose
6835 option http_proxy
6836
6837 See also : "option httpclose"
6838
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006839
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006840option independent-streams
6841no option independent-streams
6842 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6844 yes | yes | yes | yes
6845 Arguments : none
6846
6847 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6848 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6849 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6850 receive data or not.
6851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006852 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006853 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6854 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6855 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6856 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6857 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6858 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6859 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6860 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6861 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6862 socket buffers.
6863
6864 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6865 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6866 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6867 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6868 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6869
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006870 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006871 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6872 deprecated.
6873
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006874 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006875
6876
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006877option ldap-check
6878 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 yes | no | yes | yes
6881 Arguments : none
6882
6883 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6884 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6885 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6886 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6887
6888 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6889 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6890
6891 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6892 configure it.
6893
6894 Example :
6895 option ldap-check
6896
6897 See also : "option httpchk"
6898
6899
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006900option external-check
6901 Use external processes for server health checks
6902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6903 yes | no | yes | yes
6904
6905 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6906 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6907 command".
6908
6909 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6910
6911 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6912
6913
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006914option log-health-checks
6915no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006916 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 yes | no | yes | yes
6919 Arguments : none
6920
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006921 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6922 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6923 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006924
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006925 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6926 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6927 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6928 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6929 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6930
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006931 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006932 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006933
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006934 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6935 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6936 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006937
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006938
6939option log-separate-errors
6940no option log-separate-errors
6941 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6943 yes | yes | yes | no
6944 Arguments : none
6945
6946 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6947 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6948 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6949 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6950 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6951 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6952 provides very important information.
6953
6954 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6955 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6956 error logs.
6957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006958 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006959 logging.
6960
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006961
6962option logasap
6963no option logasap
6964 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6966 yes | yes | yes | no
6967 Arguments : none
6968
6969 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6970 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6971 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6972 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6973 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6974 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6975 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006976 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006977 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6978 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6979
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006980 Examples :
6981 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6982 mode http
6983 option httplog
6984 option logasap
6985 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6986
6987 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6988 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6989 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6990 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006992 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006993 logging.
6994
6995
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006996option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006997 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6999 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007000 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007001 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7002 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007003 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007004
7005 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7006 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007007 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007008 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7009 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7010 in the MySQL table, like this :
7011
7012 USE mysql;
7013 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7014 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7015
7016 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007017 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007018 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7019 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7020 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7021 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7022 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7023 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7024 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7025
7026 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7027 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007028
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007029 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007030
7031 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7032 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7033 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7034 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007035 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7036 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007037
7038 See also: "option httpchk"
7039
7040
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007041option nolinger
7042no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007043 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007044 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007046 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007047
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007048 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007049 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7050 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7051 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7052 connections.
7053
7054 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7055 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7056 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7057 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7058 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7059 this too.
7060
7061 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7062 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7063 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7064
7065 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7066 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7067 for servers.
7068
7069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7071
7072
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007073option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7074 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 yes | yes | yes | yes
7077 Arguments :
7078 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7079 matching <network>
7080 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7081 header name.
7082
7083 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7084 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7085 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7086 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7087 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7088 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7089 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7090 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7091 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7092 possible that the client has already brought one.
7093
7094 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7095 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7096 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7097 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7098 header and requires different one.
7099
7100 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7101 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7102 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7103 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7104 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7105 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7106 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7107
7108 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7109 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7110 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7111 both are defined.
7112
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007113 Examples :
7114 # Original Destination address
7115 frontend www
7116 mode http
7117 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7118
7119 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7120 backend www
7121 mode http
7122 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7123
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007124 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007125
7126
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007127option persist
7128no option persist
7129 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7130 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007132 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007133
7134 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7135 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7136 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7137 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7138 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7139 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7140 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7141 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7142 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7143 redirected to another valid server.
7144
7145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7147
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007148 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007149
7150
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007151option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7152 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7154 yes | no | yes | yes
7155 Arguments :
7156 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7157 PostgreSQL server.
7158
7159 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7160 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7161 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7162 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7163
7164 See also: "option httpchk"
7165
7166
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007167option prefer-last-server
7168no option prefer-last-server
7169 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7170 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7171 yes | no | yes | yes
7172 Arguments : none
7173
7174 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7175 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7176 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7177 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7178 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7179 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7180 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7181 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7182 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007183 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7184 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007185 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7186 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7187 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007188 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7189 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7190 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007191
7192 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7193 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7194
7195 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7196
7197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007198option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007199option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007200no option redispatch
7201 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7203 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007204 Arguments :
7205 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7206 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7207 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007208 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007209 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007210 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007211 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7212 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7213 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007215
7216 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7217 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7218 be able to access the service anymore.
7219
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007220 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7221 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007222
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007223 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007224 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7225 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007227 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7228 "redisp" keywords.
7229
7230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7232
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007233 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007234
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007235
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007236option redis-check
7237 Use redis health checks for server testing
7238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 yes | no | yes | yes
7240 Arguments : none
7241
7242 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7243 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7244 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7245 find the "+PONG" response message.
7246
7247 Example :
7248 option redis-check
7249
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007250 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007251
7252
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007253option smtpchk
7254option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7255 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7257 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007258 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007259 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007260 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007261 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7262
7263 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7264 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7265 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7266
7267 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7268 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7269 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7270 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7271 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7272 dead server.
7273
7274 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7275 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007276 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007277 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7278
7279 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7280 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7281 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7282 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007283 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007284
7285 Example :
7286 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7287
7288 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007291option socket-stats
7292no option socket-stats
7293
7294 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7296 yes | yes | yes | no
7297
7298 Arguments : none
7299
7300
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007301option splice-auto
7302no option splice-auto
7303 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7305 yes | yes | yes | yes
7306 Arguments : none
7307
7308 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7309 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007310 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007311 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007312 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007313 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7314 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7315 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7316 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7317
7318 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7319 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7320 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7321 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7322 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7323 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7324 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7325 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7326 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7327 keyword.
7328
7329 Example :
7330 option splice-auto
7331
7332 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7333 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7334
7335 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7336 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7337
7338
7339option splice-request
7340no option splice-request
7341 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 yes | yes | yes | yes
7344 Arguments : none
7345
7346 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007347 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007348 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7349 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7350 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7351 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7352
7353 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7354
7355 Example :
7356 option splice-request
7357
7358 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7359 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7360
7361 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7362 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7363
7364
7365option splice-response
7366no option splice-response
7367 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7369 yes | yes | yes | yes
7370 Arguments : none
7371
7372 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007373 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007374 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7375 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7376 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7377 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7378
7379 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7380
7381 Example :
7382 option splice-response
7383
7384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7386
7387 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7388 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7389
7390
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007391option spop-check
7392 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7394 no | no | no | yes
7395 Arguments : none
7396
7397 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7398 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7399 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7400 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7401
7402 Example :
7403 option spop-check
7404
7405 See also : "option httpchk"
7406
7407
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007408option srvtcpka
7409no option srvtcpka
7410 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7412 yes | no | yes | yes
7413 Arguments : none
7414
7415 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7416 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007417 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007418 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7419
7420 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7421 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7422 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7423 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7424
7425 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7426 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7427 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7428 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7429 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7430
7431 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7432
7433 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7434 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7435 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7436
7437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7439
7440 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7441
7442
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007443option ssl-hello-chk
7444 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7446 yes | no | yes | yes
7447 Arguments : none
7448
7449 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7450 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7451 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7452 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7453 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7454 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7455 hello message.
7456
7457 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7458 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7459 messages, which is appreciable.
7460
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007461 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7462 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7463 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007464
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007465 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7466
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007467
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007468option tcp-check
7469 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7471 yes | no | yes | yes
7472
7473 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7474 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7475
7476 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7477 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7478 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7479
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007480 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007481 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7482 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7483 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7484 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7485 only.
7486
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007487 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007488 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7489 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7490 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7491 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7492
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007493 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007494 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7495 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007496 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007497 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7498 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7499 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7500 the respective protocols.
7501 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007502 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007503
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007504 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7505 script.
7506
7507 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7508 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7509 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7510 The "comment" is of course optional.
7511
7512
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007513 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007514 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007515 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007516 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007517
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007518 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007519 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007520 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007521
7522 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7523 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007524 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007525 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007526 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007527 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007528 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007529 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007530 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7531 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007532 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007533 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7534 tcp-check expect string +OK
7535
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007536 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007537 (send many headers before analyzing)
7538 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007539 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007540 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7541 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7542 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7543 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007544 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007545
7546
7547 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7548
7549
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007550option tcp-smart-accept
7551no option tcp-smart-accept
7552 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7554 yes | yes | yes | no
7555 Arguments : none
7556
7557 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7558 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7559 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7560 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7561 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7562 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7563
7564 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7565 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7566 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7567 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7568
7569 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7570 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7571 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007572 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007573
7574 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7575 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7576 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7577
7578 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7579 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7580 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7581
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007582 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7583
7584
7585option tcp-smart-connect
7586no option tcp-smart-connect
7587 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7589 yes | no | yes | yes
7590 Arguments : none
7591
7592 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7593 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7594 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7595 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7596 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7597
7598 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7599 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7600 complex.
7601
7602 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7603 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7604 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7605
7606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7608
7609 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7610
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007611
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007612option tcpka
7613 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7615 yes | yes | yes | yes
7616 Arguments : none
7617
7618 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7619 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007620 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007621 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7622
7623 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7624 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7625 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7626 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7627
7628 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7629 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7630 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7631 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7632 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7633
7634 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7635
7636 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7637 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7638 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7639 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7640 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7641 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7642 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7643 backends.
7644
7645 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7646
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007647
7648option tcplog
7649 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007651 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007652 Arguments : none
7653
7654 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7655 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7656 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7657 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7658 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7659 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7660 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7661 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7662
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007663 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007665 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007666
7667
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007668option transparent
7669no option transparent
7670 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007672 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007673 Arguments : none
7674
7675 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7676 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7677 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7678 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7679 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7680 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7681 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7682 appropriate server.
7683
7684 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7685 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7686
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007687 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007688 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007689
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007690
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007691external-check command <command>
7692 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7694 yes | no | yes | yes
7695
7696 Arguments :
7697 <command> is the external command to run
7698
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007699 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7700
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007701 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007702
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007703 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7704 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7705 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7706 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7707 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7708 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007709
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007710 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7711
7712 Environment variables :
7713 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7714 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7715
7716 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7717
7718 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7719
7720 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7721 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7722 for a UNIX socket).
7723
7724 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7725
7726 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7727
7728 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7729
7730 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7731
7732 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7733
7734 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7735 socket).
7736
7737 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7738 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7739
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007740 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7741
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007742 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7743 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7744 failed.
7745
7746 Example :
7747 external-check command /bin/true
7748
7749 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7750
7751
7752external-check path <path>
7753 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7755 yes | no | yes | yes
7756
7757 Arguments :
7758 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7759
7760 The default path is "".
7761
7762 Example :
7763 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7764
7765 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7766 "external-check command"
7767
7768
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007769persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007770persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007771 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7773 yes | no | yes | yes
7774 Arguments :
7775 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007776 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7777 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007778
7779 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7780 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007781 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007782 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7783 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7784 forwarded to this server.
7785
7786 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7787 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7788 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007789 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007790 a single "listen" section.
7791
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007792 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7793 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7794 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7795
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007796 Example :
7797 listen tse-farm
7798 bind :3389
7799 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7800 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7801 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7802 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7803 persist rdp-cookie
7804 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007805 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007806 balance rdp-cookie
7807 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7808 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7809
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007810 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7811 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007812
7813
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007814rate-limit sessions <rate>
7815 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7817 yes | yes | yes | no
7818 Arguments :
7819 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7820 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7821
7822 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7823 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7824 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7825 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7826 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7827 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7828
7829 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7830 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7831 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7832 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7833
7834 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7835 listen smtp
7836 mode tcp
7837 bind :25
7838 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007839 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007840
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007841 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7842 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7843 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007844
7845 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7846
7847
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007848redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7849redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7850redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007851 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7853 no | yes | yes | yes
7854
7855 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007856 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007857
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007858 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007859 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007860 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7861 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7862 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007863
7864 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7865 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7866 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7867 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7868 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007869 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7870 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7871 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7872 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007873
7874 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7875 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7876 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7877 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7878 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7879 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007880 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007881 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007882 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7883 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7884 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007885
7886 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007887 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7888 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7889 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007890 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007891 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7892 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7893 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7894 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007895
7896 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007897 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007898
7899 - "drop-query"
7900 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7901 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7902 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7903 with a location-type redirect.
7904
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007905 - "append-slash"
7906 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7907 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7908 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7909 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7910
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007911 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7912 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7913 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7914 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7915 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7916 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7917 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7918
7919 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7920 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7921 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7922 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7923 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7924 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7925 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007926
7927 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7928 acl clear dst_port 80
7929 acl secure dst_port 8080
7930 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007931 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007932 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007933 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7934
7935 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007936 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7937 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7938 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007939 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007940
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007941 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7942 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7943 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7944
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007945 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007946 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007947
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007948 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007949 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7950 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7951 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007953 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007954
7955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007956redisp (deprecated)
7957redispatch (deprecated)
7958 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7960 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007961 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007962
7963 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7964 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7965 be able to access the service anymore.
7966
7967 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7968 redistribute them to a working server.
7969
7970 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7971 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7972 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007974 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7975 "option redispatch" instead.
7976
7977 See also : "option redispatch"
7978
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007979
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007980reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007981 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7983 no | yes | yes | yes
7984 Arguments :
7985 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7986 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007987 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007988
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007989 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7990 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7991
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007992 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7993 the last header of an HTTP request.
7994
7995 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7996 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7997 responses.
7998
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007999 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8000 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8001 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8002
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008003 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8004 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008005
8006
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008007reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8008reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008009 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8011 no | yes | yes | yes
8012 Arguments :
8013 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8014 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8015 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8016 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8017 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8018 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8019 ignores case.
8020
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008021 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8022 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8023
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008024 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8025 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8026 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8027 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008028 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008029
8030 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8031 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8032
8033 Example :
8034 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8035 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8036 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8037
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008038 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8039 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008040
8041
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008042reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8043reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008044 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8046 no | yes | yes | yes
8047 Arguments :
8048 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8049 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8050 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8051 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8052 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8053 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8054
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008055 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8056 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8057
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008058 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8059 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8060 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8061 next servers.
8062
8063 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8064 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8065 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8066
8067 Example :
8068 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8069 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8070 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8071
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008072 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8073 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008074
8075
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008076reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8077reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008078 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8080 no | yes | yes | yes
8081 Arguments :
8082 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8083 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8084 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8085 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8086 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8087 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8088 case.
8089
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008090 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8091 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8092
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008093 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8094 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8095 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8096 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008097 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008098
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008099 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008100 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008101 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008102
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008103 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8104 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8105
8106 Example :
8107 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8108 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8109 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8110
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008111 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8112 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008113
8114
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008115reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8116reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008117 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8119 no | yes | yes | yes
8120 Arguments :
8121 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8122 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8123 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8124 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8125 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8126 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8127 case.
8128
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008129 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8130 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8131
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008132 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8133 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8134 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8135 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8136
8137 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8138 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8139
8140 Example :
8141 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8142 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8143 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8144 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8145
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008146 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8147 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008148
8149
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008150reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8151reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008152 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8154 no | yes | yes | yes
8155 Arguments :
8156 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8157 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8158 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8159 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8160 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8161 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8162
8163 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8164 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8165 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8166 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008167 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008168
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008169 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8170 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8171
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008172 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8173 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8174 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8175
8176 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8177 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8178 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8179 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8180 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8181
8182 Example :
8183 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008184 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008185 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8186 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8187
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008188 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8189 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008190
8191
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008192reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8193reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008194 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8196 no | yes | yes | yes
8197 Arguments :
8198 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8199 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8200 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8201 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8202 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8203 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8204 ignores case.
8205
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008206 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8207 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8208
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008209 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8210 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008211 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8212 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8213 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008214 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8215 not set.
8216
8217 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8218 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8219 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8220 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8221 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8222
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008223 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008224 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008225 # block all others.
8226 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8227 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8228
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008229 # block bad guys
8230 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8231 reqitarpit . if badguys
8232
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008233 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8234 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008235
8236
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008237retries <value>
8238 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8240 yes | no | yes | yes
8241 Arguments :
8242 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8243 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8244 default value is 3.
8245
8246 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8247 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8248 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8249
8250 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008251 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8252 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008253
8254 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8255 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8256
8257 See also : "option redispatch"
8258
8259
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008260retry-on [list of keywords]
8261 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8262 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8263 yes | no | yes | yes
8264 Arguments :
8265 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8266 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8267 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8268 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8269
8270 none never retry
8271
8272 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8273 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8274
8275 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8276 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8277 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8278 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8279 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8280 processing the request.
8281
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008282 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8283 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8284 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8285 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8286 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8287 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8288 overflow attack for example).
8289
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008290 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8291 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8292 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8293 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8294 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8295 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8296 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8297 amplify denial of service attacks.
8298
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008299 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8300 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8301 considered to be safe to retry.
8302
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008303 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8304 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8305 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8306 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8307
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008308 all-retryable-errors
8309 retry request for any error that are considered
8310 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8311 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8312 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8313
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008314 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8315 not cumulative.
8316
8317 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8318 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8319 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8320 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8321
8322 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8323 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8324 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8325 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8326 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8327 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8328 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8329 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8330 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8331 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8332 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8333 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8334
8335 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8336 should not use this directive.
8337
8338 The default is "conn-failure".
8339
8340 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8341
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008342rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008343 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 no | yes | yes | yes
8346 Arguments :
8347 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8348 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008349 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008350
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008351 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8352 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8353
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008354 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8355 the last header of an HTTP response.
8356
8357 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8358 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8359 responses.
8360
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008361 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8362 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008363
8364
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008365rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8366rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008367 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8369 no | yes | yes | yes
8370 Arguments :
8371 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8372 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8373 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8374 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8375 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8376 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8377 ignores case.
8378
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008379 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8380 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8381
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008382 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8383 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008384 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008385 client.
8386
8387 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8388 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8389 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8390
8391 Example :
8392 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008393 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008394
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008395 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8396 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008397
8398
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008399rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8400rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008401 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8403 no | yes | yes | yes
8404 Arguments :
8405 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8406 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8407 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8408 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8409 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8410 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8411 ignores case.
8412
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008413 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8414 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8415
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008416 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8417 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8418 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8419 case-sensitive.
8420
8421 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008422 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8423 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8424 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008425
8426 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8427 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8428
8429 Example :
8430 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8431 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8432
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008433 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8434 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008435
8436
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008437rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8438rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008439 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8441 no | yes | yes | yes
8442 Arguments :
8443 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8444 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8445 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8446 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8447 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8448 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8449 ignores case.
8450
8451 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8452 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8453 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8454 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008455 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008456
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008457 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8458 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8459
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008460 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8461 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8462 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8463
8464 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8465 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8466 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8467 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8468 are not case-sensitive.
8469
8470 Example :
8471 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8472 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8473
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008474 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8475 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008476
8477
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008478server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008479 Declare a server in a backend
8480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8481 no | no | yes | yes
8482 Arguments :
8483 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008484 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008485 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008486
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008487 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8488 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8489 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8490 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008491 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8492 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8493 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8494 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8495 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008496 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8497 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8498 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8499 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8500 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8501 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8502 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008503 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008504 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8505 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8506 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8507 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8508 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8509 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008510 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8511 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008512 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8513 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008514
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008515 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008516 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8517 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8518 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8519 adding this value to the client's port.
8520
8521 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8522 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008523 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008524
8525 Examples :
8526 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8527 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008528 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008529 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8530 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8531 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008532
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008533 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8534 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8535 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8536 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8537 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8538
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008539 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8540 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008541
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008542server-state-file-name [<file>]
8543 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8544 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8545 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8546 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8547 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8548 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8549
8550 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8551 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8552
8553 global
8554 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8555
8556 backend bk
8557 load-server-state-from-file
8558
8559 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8560 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008561
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008562server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8563 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8564 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8566 no | no | yes | yes
8567
8568 Arguments:
8569 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8570
8571 <num | range>
8572 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8573 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8574 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8575 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8576
8577 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8578
8579 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8580
8581 <params*>
8582 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8583 keyword.
8584
8585 Examples:
8586 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8587 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8588 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8589
8590 # or
8591 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8592
8593 # would be equivalent to:
8594 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8595 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8596 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8597
8598
8599
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008600source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008601source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008602source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008603 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8605 yes | no | yes | yes
8606 Arguments :
8607 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8608 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008609
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008610 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008611 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8612 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8613 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8614 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8615 supported prefixes are :
8616 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8617 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8618 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008619 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008620 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8621 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008622
8623 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8624 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008625 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8626 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8627 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008628
8629 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8630 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8631 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8632 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8633 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8634 <addr>.
8635
8636 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8637 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8638 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8639 port.
8640
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008641 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8642 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8643 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8644 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008645 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008646 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8647 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8648 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8649 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8650 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8651 HTTP header.
8652
8653 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8654 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008655 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008656 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8657 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8658 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8659 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8660 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8661 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8662 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8663
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008664 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8665 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8666 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8667 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8668 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8669 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8670
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008671 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8672 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8673 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8674 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8675
8676 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8677 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8678 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8679 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8680 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8681 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8682
8683 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8684 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8685 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8686 there are two methods :
8687
8688 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8689 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8690 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8691 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8692 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8693 of the client ranges may be used.
8694
8695 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8696 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8697 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8698 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8699 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8700 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8701 same session.
8702
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008703 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8704 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8705 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008706 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008707
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008708 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8709
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008710 Examples :
8711 backend private
8712 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8713 source 192.168.1.200
8714
8715 backend transparent_ssl1
8716 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8717 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8718
8719 backend transparent_ssl2
8720 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8721 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8722 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8723
8724 backend transparent_ssl3
8725 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8726 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8727 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8728
8729 backend transparent_smtp
8730 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8731 # with Tproxy version 4.
8732 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8733
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008734 backend transparent_http
8735 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8736 # proxy.
8737 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008739 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008740 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008742
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008743srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8744 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8746 yes | no | yes | yes
8747 Arguments :
8748 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8750 as explained at the top of this document.
8751
8752 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8753 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8754 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8755 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8756 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8757 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8758 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8759
8760 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8761 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8762 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8763 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8764 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008765 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008766 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008767 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008768
8769 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8770 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8771 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8772 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8773 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8774 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8775
8776 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8777 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8778
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008779 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8780 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008781
8782
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008783stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8784 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008786 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008787
8788 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8789 matched.
8790
8791 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8792 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8793
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008794 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8795 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008796 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008797
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008798 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8799 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8800 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8801 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008802
8803 Example :
8804 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8805 backend stats_localhost
8806 stats enable
8807 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8808
8809 Example :
8810 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8811 backend stats_auth
8812 stats enable
8813 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8814 stats admin if TRUE
8815
8816 Example :
8817 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8818 userlist stats-auth
8819 group admin users admin
8820 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8821 group readonly users haproxy
8822 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8823
8824 backend stats_auth
8825 stats enable
8826 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8827 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8828 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8829 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8830
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008831 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8832 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8833 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008834
8835
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008836stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8837 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008839 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008840 Arguments :
8841 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8842
8843 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8844
8845 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8846 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8847 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8848 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8849 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8850 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8851
8852 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8853 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8854 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008855 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008856
8857 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8858 report using "stats scope".
8859
8860 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8861 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8862 unobvious parameters.
8863
8864 Example :
8865 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8866 backend public_www
8867 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8868 stats enable
8869 stats hide-version
8870 stats scope .
8871 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008872 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008873 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8874 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8875
8876 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8877 backend private_monitoring
8878 stats enable
8879 stats uri /admin?stats
8880 stats refresh 5s
8881
8882 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8883
8884
8885stats enable
8886 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008888 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008889 Arguments : none
8890
8891 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8892 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8893 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8894 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8895 - stats auth : no authentication
8896 - stats scope : no restriction
8897
8898 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8899 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8900 unobvious parameters.
8901
8902 Example :
8903 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8904 backend public_www
8905 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8906 stats enable
8907 stats hide-version
8908 stats scope .
8909 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008910 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008911 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8912 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8913
8914 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8915 backend private_monitoring
8916 stats enable
8917 stats uri /admin?stats
8918 stats refresh 5s
8919
8920 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8921
8922
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008923stats hide-version
8924 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008926 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008927 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008928
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008929 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8930 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8931 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8932 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8933 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8934 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008936 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8937 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8938 unobvious parameters.
8939
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940 Example :
8941 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8942 backend public_www
8943 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008944 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008945 stats hide-version
8946 stats scope .
8947 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008948 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008949 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8950 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008951
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008952 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8953 backend private_monitoring
8954 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008955 stats uri /admin?stats
8956 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008957
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008958 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008959
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008960
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008961stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8963 Access control for statistics
8964
8965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8966 no | no | yes | yes
8967
8968 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8969 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8970 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8971 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8972 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8973 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8974
8975 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8976 instance.
8977
8978 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8979 about ACL usage.
8980
8981
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008982stats realm <realm>
8983 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008985 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008986 Arguments :
8987 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8988 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8989 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8990
8991 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8992 using a backslash ('\').
8993
8994 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8995 only related to authentication.
8996
8997 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8998 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8999 unobvious parameters.
9000
9001 Example :
9002 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9003 backend public_www
9004 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9005 stats enable
9006 stats hide-version
9007 stats scope .
9008 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009009 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009010 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9011 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9012
9013 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9014 backend private_monitoring
9015 stats enable
9016 stats uri /admin?stats
9017 stats refresh 5s
9018
9019 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9020
9021
9022stats refresh <delay>
9023 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009025 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009026 Arguments :
9027 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9028 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9029 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9030 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9031 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9032 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9033
9034 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9035 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9036 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9037 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9038
9039 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9040 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9041 unobvious parameters.
9042
9043 Example :
9044 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9045 backend public_www
9046 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9047 stats enable
9048 stats hide-version
9049 stats scope .
9050 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009051 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009052 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9053 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9054
9055 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9056 backend private_monitoring
9057 stats enable
9058 stats uri /admin?stats
9059 stats refresh 5s
9060
9061 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9062
9063
9064stats scope { <name> | "." }
9065 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009067 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009068 Arguments :
9069 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9070 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9071 section in which the statement appears.
9072
9073 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9074 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9075 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9076 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9077 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9078 exists.
9079
9080 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9081 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9082 unobvious parameters.
9083
9084 Example :
9085 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9086 backend public_www
9087 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9088 stats enable
9089 stats hide-version
9090 stats scope .
9091 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009092 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009093 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9094 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9095
9096 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9097 backend private_monitoring
9098 stats enable
9099 stats uri /admin?stats
9100 stats refresh 5s
9101
9102 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9103
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009104
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009105stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009106 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009108 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009109
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009110 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009111 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9112
9113 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9114 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9115
9116 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9117 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009118 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009119
9120 Example :
9121 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9122 backend private_monitoring
9123 stats enable
9124 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9125 stats uri /admin?stats
9126 stats refresh 5s
9127
9128 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9129 global section.
9130
9131
9132stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009133 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9135 yes | yes | yes | yes
9136 Arguments : none
9137
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009138 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009139 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9140 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9141 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9142 - IP (socket, server)
9143 - cookie (backend, server)
9144
9145 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9146 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009147 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009148
9149 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9150
9151
9152stats show-node [ <name> ]
9153 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009155 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009156 Arguments:
9157 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9158 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9159
9160 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9161 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009162 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009163
9164 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9165 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9166 unobvious parameters.
9167
9168 Example:
9169 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9170 backend private_monitoring
9171 stats enable
9172 stats show-node Europe-1
9173 stats uri /admin?stats
9174 stats refresh 5s
9175
9176 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9177 section.
9178
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009179
9180stats uri <prefix>
9181 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009183 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009184 Arguments :
9185 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9186 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9187 query string.
9188
9189 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9190 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9191 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9192 possible to reach it in the application.
9193
9194 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009195 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009196 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9197 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9198 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9199 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9200
9201 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9202 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9203 an address or a port to statistics only.
9204
9205 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9206 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9207 unobvious parameters.
9208
9209 Example :
9210 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9211 backend public_www
9212 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9213 stats enable
9214 stats hide-version
9215 stats scope .
9216 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009217 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009218 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9219 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9220
9221 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9222 backend private_monitoring
9223 stats enable
9224 stats uri /admin?stats
9225 stats refresh 5s
9226
9227 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9228
9229
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009230stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9231 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009233 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009234
9235 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009236 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009237 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009238 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009239 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9240
9241 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9242 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9243 the "stick-table" statement.
9244
9245 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9246 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9247 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9248 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9249 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9250
9251 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9252 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9253 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9254 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9255 transformation rules.
9256
9257 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9258 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9259 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9260 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9261 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9262 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9263 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9264
9265 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9266 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9267 ACL based conditions.
9268
9269 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9270 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9271 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9272 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9273
9274 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9275 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9276 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9277 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9278
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009279 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9280 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009281 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009282
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009283 Example :
9284 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9285 # last 30 minutes
9286 backend pop
9287 mode tcp
9288 balance roundrobin
9289 stick store-request src
9290 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9291 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9292 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9293
9294 backend smtp
9295 mode tcp
9296 balance roundrobin
9297 stick match src table pop
9298 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9299 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9300
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009301 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009302 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009303
9304
9305stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9306 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9308 no | no | yes | yes
9309
9310 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9311 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9312 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9313 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9314
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009315 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9316 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009317 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009318
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009319 Examples :
9320 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009321 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009322
9323 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9324 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9325 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9326
9327
9328 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9329 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9330 backend http
9331 mode http
9332 balance roundrobin
9333 stick on src table https
9334 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9335 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9336 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9337
9338 backend https
9339 mode tcp
9340 balance roundrobin
9341 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9342 stick on src
9343 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9344 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9345
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009346 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009347
9348
9349stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9350 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9352 no | no | yes | yes
9353
9354 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009355 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009356 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009357 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009358 server is selected.
9359
9360 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9361 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9362 the "stick-table" statement.
9363
9364 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9365 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9366 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9367 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9368 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9369 address.
9370
9371 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9372 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9373 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9374 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9375 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9376 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9377 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9378 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9379 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9380 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9381
9382 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9383 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9384 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9385 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9386 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9387 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9388 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9389
9390 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9391 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9392 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9393 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9394
9395 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9396 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9397 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9398 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9399 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9400 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009401 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9402 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9403 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9404 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9405 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9406 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009407
9408 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9409 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9410 the request.
9411
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009412 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9413 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009414 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009415
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009416 Example :
9417 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9418 # last 30 minutes
9419 backend pop
9420 mode tcp
9421 balance roundrobin
9422 stick store-request src
9423 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9424 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9425 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9426
9427 backend smtp
9428 mode tcp
9429 balance roundrobin
9430 stick match src table pop
9431 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9432 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9433
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009434 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009435 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009436
9437
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009438stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009439 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9440 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009441 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009443 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009444
9445 Arguments :
9446 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9447 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9448 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9449 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9450
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009451 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9452 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9453 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9454 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9455
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009456 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9457 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9458 instance.
9459
9460 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9461 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9462 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9463 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9464 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9465 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009466 to 32 characters.
9467
9468 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9469 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9470 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009471 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009472 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9473 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009474
9475 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009476 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9477 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009478 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9479 increase.
9480
9481 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009482 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9483 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9484 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009485
9486 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9487 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9488 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9489 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009490 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009491 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9492 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9493 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9494 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9495 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9496 parameter (see below).
9497
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009498 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9499 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9500 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9501 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9502 soft restart.
9503
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009504 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9505 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009506
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009507 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9508 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9509 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9510 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009511 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009512 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009513 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9514 if not expiration delay is specified.
9515
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009516 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9517 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9518 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9519 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009520 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9521 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9522 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9523 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9524 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9525 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9526 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9527 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9528 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9529 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9530 types and their arguments.
9531
9532 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9533 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9534 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9535 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9536
9537 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9538 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9539 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009540 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009541
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009542 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9543 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9544 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009545 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009546 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009547 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009548
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009549 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9550 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9551 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9552 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9553
9554 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9555 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9556 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9557 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9558 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9559 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9560
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009561 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9562 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9563 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9564 they were received.
9565
9566 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9567 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9568 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9569 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9570 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9571
9572 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9573 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9574 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9575 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9576 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9577
9578 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9579 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9580 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9581
9582 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9583 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9584 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9585 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9586 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9587
9588 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9589 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9590 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9591 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9592 the client side.
9593
9594 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9595 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9596 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9597 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9598 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9599 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9600 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9601
9602 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9603 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9604 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9605 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9606 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9607 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009608 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009609
9610 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9611 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9612 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9613 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9614 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9615 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9616
9617 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009618 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009619 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9620 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9621
9622 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9623 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9624 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9625 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9626 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9627 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9628 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9629 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9630 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9631 recommended for better fairness.
9632
9633 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009634 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009635 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9636 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9637
9638 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9639 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9640 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9641 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9642 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9643 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9644 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9645 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9646 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9647 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009648
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009649 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9650 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009651 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9652 reference it.
9653
9654 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9655 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009656 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9657 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9658 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009659
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009660 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9661 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9662 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9663 something that can be ignored.
9664
9665 Example:
9666 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9667 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9668 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9669 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9670
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009671 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009672 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009673
9674
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009675stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009676 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9678 no | no | yes | yes
9679
9680 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009681 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009682 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009683 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009684 server is selected.
9685
9686 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9687 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9688 the "stick-table" statement.
9689
9690 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9691 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9692 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9693 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9694
9695 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9696 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9697 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9698 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9699 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9700 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009701 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009702 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9703 rules.
9704
9705 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9706 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9707 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9708 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9709 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9710 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9711 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9712
9713 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9714 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9715 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9716 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9717
9718 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9719 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9720 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9721 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9722 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9723 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009724 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9725 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9726 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9727 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9728 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9729 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9730 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9731 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9732 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009733
9734 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9735
9736 Example :
9737 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9738 backend https
9739 mode tcp
9740 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009741 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009742 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009743
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009744 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9745 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9746
9747 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9748 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9749 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9750
9751 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9752 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009753
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009754 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9755 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9756 # at offset 44.
9757
9758 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9759 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9760
9761 # Learn on response if server hello.
9762 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009763
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009764 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9765 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9766
9767 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9768 extraction.
9769
9770
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009771tcp-check connect [params*]
9772 Opens a new connection
9773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9774 no | no | yes | yes
9775
9776 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9777 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9778 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9779
9780 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9781 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9782 of the sequence.
9783
9784 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9785 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9786 do.
9787
9788 Parameters :
9789 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9790 use the TCP connection.
9791
9792 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9793 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9794 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9795
9796 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9797
9798 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9799
9800 Examples:
9801 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9802 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9803 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9804 option tcp-check
9805 tcp-check connect
9806 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9807 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9808 tcp-check send \r\n
9809 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9810 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9811 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9812 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9813 tcp-check send \r\n
9814 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9815 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9816
9817 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9818 option tcp-check
9819 tcp-check connect port 110
9820 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9821 tcp-check connect port 143
9822 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9823 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9824
9825 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9826
9827
9828tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009829 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9831 no | no | yes | yes
9832
9833 Arguments :
9834 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9835 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9836 binary.
9837 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9838 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9839 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9840
9841 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9842 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9843 with the usual backslash ('\').
9844 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009845 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009846 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9847 used upper or lower case.
9848
9849
9850 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9851
9852 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9853 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9854 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9855 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9856 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9857 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9858 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9859 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9860
9861 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9862 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9863 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9864 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9865 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9866 expression.
9867
9868 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9869 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9870 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9871 this exact hexadecimal string.
9872 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9873
9874 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9875 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9876 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9877 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9878 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9879 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9880 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9881 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9882 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9883 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9884 the null character.
9885
9886 Examples :
9887 # perform a POP check
9888 option tcp-check
9889 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9890
9891 # perform an IMAP check
9892 option tcp-check
9893 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9894
9895 # look for the redis master server
9896 option tcp-check
9897 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009898 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009899 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9900 tcp-check expect string role:master
9901 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9902 tcp-check expect string +OK
9903
9904
9905 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9906 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9907
9908
9909tcp-check send <data>
9910 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9912 no | no | yes | yes
9913
9914 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9915 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9916
9917 Examples :
9918 # look for the redis master server
9919 option tcp-check
9920 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9921 tcp-check expect string role:master
9922
9923 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9924 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9925
9926
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009927tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9928 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009929 tcp health check
9930 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9931 no | no | yes | yes
9932
9933 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9934 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009935 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009936 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9937 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9938 hexadecimal string.
9939 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9940
9941 Examples :
9942 # redis check in binary
9943 option tcp-check
9944 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9945 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9946
9947
9948 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9949 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9950
9951
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009952tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9953 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9955 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009956 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009957 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9958 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009960 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009961
9962 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9963 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009964 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9965 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9966 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9967 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9968 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9969 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009970
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009971 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9972 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9973 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9974 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009975
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009976 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009977 - accept :
9978 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9979 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9980 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009982 - reject :
9983 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9984 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9985 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9986 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9987 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9988 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9989 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9990 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9991 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9992 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9993 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009994 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009995
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009996 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9997 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9998 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9999 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10000 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10001 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10002 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10003 hosts.
10004
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010005 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10006 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10007 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10008 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10009 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10010 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10011 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10012 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10013
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010014 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10015 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10016 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10017 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10018 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10019 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10020 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10021 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10022 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010023 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10024 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010025
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010026 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010027 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010028 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10029 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10030 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010031 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010032 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10033 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10034 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10035 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10036 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10037 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10038 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10039 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010041 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010042 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010043 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010044 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010045 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10046 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10047 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010049 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10050 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10051 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10052 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010054 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10055 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10056 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10057 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10058 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010059 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10060 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10061 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10062 layer7 information is extracted.
10063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010064 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10065 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10066 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10067 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10068 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010069
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010070 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10071 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10072 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10073 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10074
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010075 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10076 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10077 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10078 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10079
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010080 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10081 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10082 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10083 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10084 continues.
10085
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010086 - set-src <expr> :
10087 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10088 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10089 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010090 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010092 Arguments:
10093 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10094 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010095
10096 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010097 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10098
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010099 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10100 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010101
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010102 - set-src-port <expr> :
10103 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10104 expression.
10105
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010106 Arguments:
10107 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10108 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010109
10110 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010111 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10112
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010113 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10114 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10115 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010116
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010117 - set-dst <expr> :
10118 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10119 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10120 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10121 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10122 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10123
10124 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10125 followed by some converters.
10126
10127 Example:
10128
10129 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10130 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10131
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010132 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10133 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10134
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010135 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10136 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10137 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10138 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10139
10140
10141 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10142 followed by some converters.
10143
10144 Example:
10145
10146 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10147
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010148 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10149 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10150 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10151
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010152 - "silent-drop" :
10153 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010154 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010155 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10156 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10157 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10158 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10159 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010160 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10161 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010162 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10163 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010164 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010165 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10166 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10167 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10168 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010170 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10171 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10172 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010174 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10175 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10176 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010177
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010178 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010179 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010180 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010182 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10183 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10184 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010185
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010186 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010187 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10188 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010189
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010190 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10191
10192 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10193
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010194 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10195
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010196 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010197
10198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010199tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10200 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010202 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010203 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010204 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10205 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010206
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010207 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010208
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010209 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010210 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10211 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10212 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10213 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010215 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10216 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10217 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10218 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010219 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10220 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10221 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10222 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10223 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10224 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010225 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010226 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010228 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10229 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10230 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10231 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010232
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010233 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010234 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010235 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010236 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10237 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010238 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010239 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010240 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010241 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010242 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010243 - set-dst <expr>
10244 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010245 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010246 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010247 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010248 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010249 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010251 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10252 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010253 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10254 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010255
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010256 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10257 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10258 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10259 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10260 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10261 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010263 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010264 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10265 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010267 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010268 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10269 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10270 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10271 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010272 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10273 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10274 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010275
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010276 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010277 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10278 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10279 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010280
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010281 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10282 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10283
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010284 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010285 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10286 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010287
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010288 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10289 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010290 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010291 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10292 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010293 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010294 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010295 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010296 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10297 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010298 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010299 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10300 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010301
10302 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10303 followed by some converters.
10304
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010305 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10306 <var-name>.
10307
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010308 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10309 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10310 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10311 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10312 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10313
10314 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10315 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10316 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10317 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10318 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10319 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10320 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10321 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10322 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10323 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10324 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10325
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010326 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10327 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10328 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10329 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10330 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10331
10332 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10333
10334 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10335
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010336 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10337 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10338 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10339 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10340 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10341 evaluated.
10342
10343 Example:
10344 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10345
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010346 Example:
10347
10348 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010349 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010350
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010351 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010352 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10353 # and reject everything else.
10354 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10355 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010356 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010357 tcp-request content reject
10358
10359 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010360 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10361 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10362 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010363 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010364
10365 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10366 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10367 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010368 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010369 tcp-request content reject
10370
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010371 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010372 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010373 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010374 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010375 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10376 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010377
10378 Example:
10379 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10380 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010381 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010382
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010383 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010384 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010385
10386 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010387 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010388 # protecting all our sites
10389 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010390 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10391 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010392 ...
10393 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10394
10395 backend http_dynamic
10396 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010397 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010398 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010399 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010400 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010401 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010402 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010404 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010405
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010406 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10407 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010408
10409
10410tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10411 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010413 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010414 Arguments :
10415 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10416 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10417 as explained at the top of this document.
10418
10419 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10420 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10421 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10422 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10423 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10424
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010425 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10426 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10427 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10428 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10429
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010430 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10431 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010432 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010433 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010434 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10435 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10436 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10437 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010438
10439 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10440 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10441 it pass through unaffected.
10442
10443 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10444 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10445 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010446 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010447 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10448 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010449 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10450 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10451 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010452
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010453 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010454 "timeout client".
10455
10456
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010457tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10458 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10460 no | no | yes | yes
10461 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010462 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10463 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010464
10465 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10466
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010467 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010468 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10469 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010470 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10471 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010472
10473 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10474
10475 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10476 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10477 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10478 inserted.
10479
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010480 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010481 - accept :
10482 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10483 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10484 the rules evaluation.
10485
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010486 - close :
10487 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10488 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10489 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10490 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10491 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10492 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010493 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010494 protocols.
10495
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010496 - reject :
10497 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10498 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010499 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010500
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010501 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10502 Sets a variable.
10503
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010504 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10505 Unsets a variable.
10506
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010507 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10508 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10509 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10510 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10511
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010512 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10513 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10514 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10515 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10516
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010517 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10518 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10519 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10520 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10521 continues.
10522
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010523 - "silent-drop" :
10524 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010525 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010526 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10527 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10528 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10529 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10530 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010531 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10532 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010533 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10534 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010535 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010536 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10537 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10538 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10539 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10540
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010541 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10542 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10543
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010544 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10545 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10546 for changing the default action to a reject.
10547
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010548 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10549 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10550 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10551 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010552 period.
10553
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010554 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10555 declared inline.
10556
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010557 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10558 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010559 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010560 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10561 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010562 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010563 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010564 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010565 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10566 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010567 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010568 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10569 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010570
10571 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10572 followed by some converters.
10573
10574 Example:
10575
10576 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10577
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010578 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10579 <var-name>.
10580
10581 Example:
10582
10583 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10584
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010585 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10586 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10587 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10588 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10589 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10590
10591 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10592
10593 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10594
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010595 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10596
10597 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10598
10599
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010600tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10601 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10603 no | yes | yes | no
10604 Arguments :
10605 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10606 below.
10607
10608 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10609
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010610 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010611 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10612 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10613 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10614 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10615 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10616 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10617 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010618 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010619 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10620 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10621 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10622 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10623 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10624 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10625 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10626 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10627 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10628 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10629 instead.
10630
10631 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10632 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10633 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10634 rules which may be inserted.
10635
10636 Several types of actions are supported :
10637 - accept : the request is accepted
10638 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10639 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10640 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010641 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010642 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10643 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010644 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010645 - silent-drop
10646
10647 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10648 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10649 sections for a complete description.
10650
10651 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10652 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10653 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10654
10655 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10656 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10657 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10658 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10659 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10660
10661 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10662 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10663
10664 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10665 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10666 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10667
10668 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10669 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10670 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10671
10672 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10673 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10674 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10675
10676 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10677 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10678 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10679
10680 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10681
10682 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10683
10684
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010685tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10686 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10688 no | no | yes | yes
10689 Arguments :
10690 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10691 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10692 as explained at the top of this document.
10693
10694 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10695
10696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010697timeout check <timeout>
10698 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10699 established.
10700
10701 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10702 yes | no | yes | yes
10703 Arguments:
10704 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10705 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10706 as explained at the top of this document.
10707
10708 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10709 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010710 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010711 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010712 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10713 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10714 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010715
10716 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10717 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10718
10719 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10720 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010721 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010722
10723 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10724 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10725 forget about it.
10726
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010727 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10728 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010729
10730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010731timeout client <timeout>
10732timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10733 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10735 yes | yes | yes | no
10736 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010737 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010738 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10739 as explained at the top of this document.
10740
10741 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10742 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10743 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010744 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10745 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10746 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10747 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010748 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10749 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10750 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010751 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010752 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010753 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10754 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010755 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10756 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010757
10758 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10759 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10760 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10761 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010762 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010763 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10764
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010765 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010767 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10768 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10769 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10770
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010771 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10772 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010773
10774
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010775timeout client-fin <timeout>
10776 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10778 yes | yes | yes | no
10779 Arguments :
10780 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10781 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10782 as explained at the top of this document.
10783
10784 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10785 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10786 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10787 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10788 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10789 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10790 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010791 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10792 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10793 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010794
10795 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10796 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10797 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10798
10799 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10800
10801
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010802timeout connect <timeout>
10803timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10804 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10806 yes | no | yes | yes
10807 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010808 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010809 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10810 as explained at the top of this document.
10811
10812 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010813 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010814 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010815 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010816 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10817 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010818
10819 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10820 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10821 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10822 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010823 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010824 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10825
10826 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10827 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10828 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10829
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010830 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10831 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010832
10833
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010834timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10835 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10837 yes | yes | yes | yes
10838 Arguments :
10839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10841 as explained at the top of this document.
10842
10843 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10844 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10845 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10846 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10847 once the request has started to present itself.
10848
10849 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10850 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10851 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10852 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10853 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10854
10855 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10856 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10857 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10858 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10859
10860 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10861 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010862 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010863 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10864 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010865 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010866
10867 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10868 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10869 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10870 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10871
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010872 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10873 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010874 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10875
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010876 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10877
10878
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010879timeout http-request <timeout>
10880 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010882 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010883 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010884 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010885 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10886 as explained at the top of this document.
10887
10888 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10889 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10890 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10891 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10892 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10893 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10894 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010895 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10896 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10897 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10898 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010899 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010900 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10901 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010902
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010903 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10904 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10905 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10906 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10907 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010908 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010909
10910 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10911 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010912 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010913 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10914 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10915
10916 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010917 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10918 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10919 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010920
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010921 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010922 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010923
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010924
10925timeout queue <timeout>
10926 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10928 yes | no | yes | yes
10929 Arguments :
10930 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10931 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10932 as explained at the top of this document.
10933
10934 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10935 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10936 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10937 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10938 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10939
10940 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10941 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10942 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10943 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10944
10945 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10946
10947
10948timeout server <timeout>
10949timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10950 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10952 yes | no | yes | yes
10953 Arguments :
10954 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10955 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10956 as explained at the top of this document.
10957
10958 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10959 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10960 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10961 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10962 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10963 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10964 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10965
10966 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10967 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10968 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10969 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10970 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010971 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010972 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010973 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10974 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010975 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10976 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010977
10978 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10979 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10980 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10981 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010982 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010983 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10984
10985 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10986 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10987 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10988
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010989 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010990
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010991
10992timeout server-fin <timeout>
10993 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10995 yes | no | yes | yes
10996 Arguments :
10997 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10998 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10999 as explained at the top of this document.
11000
11001 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11002 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11003 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11004 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11005 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11006 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11007 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11008 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11009 situations, it should not be needed.
11010
11011 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11012 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11013 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11014
11015 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11016
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011017
11018timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011019 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11021 yes | yes | yes | yes
11022 Arguments :
11023 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11024 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11025 as explained at the top of this document.
11026
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011027 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11028 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11029 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11030 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011031
11032 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11033 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11034 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11035 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011036 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011037
11038 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11039
11040
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011041timeout tunnel <timeout>
11042 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11044 yes | no | yes | yes
11045 Arguments :
11046 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11047 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11048 as explained at the top of this document.
11049
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011050 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011051 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11052 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11053 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011054 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11055 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011056 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11057 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11058 specified.
11059
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011060 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11061 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11062 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11063 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11064 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11065 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11066 state.
11067
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011068 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11069 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11070 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11071 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011072 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011073
11074 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11075 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11076 forget about it.
11077
11078 Example :
11079 defaults http
11080 option http-server-close
11081 timeout connect 5s
11082 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011083 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011084 timeout server 30s
11085 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11086
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011087 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011088
11089
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011090transparent (deprecated)
11091 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011093 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011094 Arguments : none
11095
11096 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11097 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11098 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11099 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11100 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11101 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11102 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11103 appropriate server.
11104
11105 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11106
11107 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11108 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11109
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011110 See also: "option transparent"
11111
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011112unique-id-format <string>
11113 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11115 yes | yes | yes | no
11116 Arguments :
11117 <string> is a log-format string.
11118
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011119 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11120 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11121 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11122 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011123
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011124 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11125 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11126 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11127 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11128 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11129 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11130 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11131 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011132
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011133 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11134 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011135
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011136 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011137
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011138 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011139
11140 will generate:
11141
11142 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11143
11144 See also: "unique-id-header"
11145
11146unique-id-header <name>
11147 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11149 yes | yes | yes | no
11150 Arguments :
11151 <name> is the name of the header.
11152
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011153 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11154 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011155
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011156 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011157
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011158 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011159 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11160
11161 will generate:
11162
11163 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11164
11165 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011166
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011167use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011168 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11170 no | yes | yes | no
11171 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011172 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11173 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011174
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011175 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11176 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011177
11178 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11179 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11180 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011181 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011182 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011183 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11184 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011185
11186 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11187 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11188 assign the backend.
11189
11190 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11191 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11192 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11193 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11194 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11195 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11196
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011197 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011198 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011199 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11200 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11201 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11202
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011203 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11204 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11205 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11206 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11207 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11208 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11209 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11210 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11211 cannot be forced from the request.
11212
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011213 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011214 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11215 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11216
11217 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11218 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011219
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011220
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011221use-server <server> if <condition>
11222use-server <server> unless <condition>
11223 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11225 no | no | yes | yes
11226 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011227 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011228
11229 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11230
11231 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11232 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11233 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11234
11235 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11236 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11237 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11238 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11239 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11240 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11241 matches will assign the server.
11242
11243 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11244 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11245 with the next rules until one matches.
11246
11247 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11248 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11249 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11250 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11251
11252 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11253 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11254 stripped.
11255
11256 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11257 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11258 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11259 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11260
11261 Example :
11262 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11263 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11264 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11265 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11266 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11267 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011268 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011269 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11270 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11271
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011272 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011273
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100112755. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011276--------------------------
11277
11278The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11279depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11280settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11281written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11282described in this section.
11283
11284
112855.1. Bind options
11286-----------------
11287
11288The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11289as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11290no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11291parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11292while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11293provided immediately after the setting name.
11294
11295The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11296
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011297accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11298 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11299 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11300 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11301 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11302 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11303 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11304 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11305 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11306 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011307 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11308 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11309 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011310
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011311accept-proxy
11312 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011313 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11314 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011315 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11316 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11317 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11318 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011319 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011320 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11321 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011322 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11323 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011324
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011325allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011326 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011327 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011328 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011329 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11330 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011331
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011332alpn <protocols>
11333 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11334 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11335 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011336 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011337 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011338 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11339 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11340 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11341 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11342 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11343 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11344 preference, like below :
11345
11346 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011348backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011349 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011350 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11351
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011352curves <curves>
11353 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11354 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11355 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11356 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11357 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11358 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11359
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011360ecdhe <named curve>
11361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011362 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11363 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011364
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011365ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11367 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11368 client's certificate.
11369
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011370ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11372 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11373 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11374 error is ignored.
11375
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011376ca-sign-file <cafile>
11377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11378 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11379 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11380 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11381 'generate-certificates' for details.
11382
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011383ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11385 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11386 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11387 'generate-certificates' for details.
11388
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011389ciphers <ciphers>
11390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11391 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011392 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011393 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011394 information and recommendations see e.g.
11395 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11396 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11397 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11398
11399ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11400 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11401 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11402 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11403 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011404 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11405 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011406
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011407crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011408 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11409 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11410 to verify client's certificate.
11411
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011412crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011413 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11414 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11415 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11416 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11417 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11418 file.
11419
11420 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11421 are loaded.
11422
11423 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011424 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011425 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11426 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11427 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11428 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011429 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11430 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011431 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011432
11433 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11434 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11435 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11436 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011437 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11438 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011439
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011440 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011441
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011442 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011443 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011444 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11445 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011446 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11447 clients).
11448
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011449 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11450 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11451 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11452 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11453 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11454 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11455 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11456 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11457 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11458 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11459 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11460 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11461 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11462
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011463 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11464 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11465 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11466 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11467 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11468
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011469 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11470 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11471 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11472 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011473
11474 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11475 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11476 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11477 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11478 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11479 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11480 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11481 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11482 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11483
11484 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11485
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011486 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011487 a cert bundle.
11488
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011489 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011490 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11491 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11492 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11493 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11494 provide multi-cert support.
11495
11496 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11497
11498 Filename | CN | SAN
11499 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11500 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011501 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011502 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11503 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11504
11505 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11506 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11507 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11508 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011509 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11510 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11511 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011512
11513 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11514 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11515
11516 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11517 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11518 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11519
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011520crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011521 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011522 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011523 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011524 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011525
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011526crt-list <file>
11527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011528 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11529 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011530
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011531 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11532
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011533 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11534 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011535 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011536 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011537
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011538 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11539 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11540 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11541 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11542 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11543 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11544 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11545 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011546
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011547 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011548 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011549 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11550 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11551 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011552
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011553 crt-list file example:
11554 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011555 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011556 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011557 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011558
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011559defer-accept
11560 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11561 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11562 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011563 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011564 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11565 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11566 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11567 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11568 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11569 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11570 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11571
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011572expose-fd listeners
11573 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11574 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011575 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11576 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011577 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011578
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011579force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011580 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011581 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011582 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011583 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011584
11585force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011586 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011587 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011588 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011589
11590force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011591 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011592 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011593 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011594
11595force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011596 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011597 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011598 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011599
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011600force-tlsv13
11601 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11602 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011603 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011604
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011605generate-certificates
11606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11607 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11608 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11609 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11610 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11611 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11612 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11613 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11614 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11615 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11616 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11617
11618 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11619 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011620 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011621 certificate is used many times.
11622
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011623gid <gid>
11624 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11625 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11626 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11627 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11628 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11629
11630group <group>
11631 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11632 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11633 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11634 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11635 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11636
11637id <id>
11638 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11639 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11640 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11641 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11642
11643interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011644 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11645 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11646 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11647 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11648 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11649 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011650 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11651 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11652 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11653 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11654 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11655 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011656
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011657level <level>
11658 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11659 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11660 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011661 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011662 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11663 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11664 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011665 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011666 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011667 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011668 all counters).
11669
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011670severity-output <format>
11671 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11672 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11673 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11674 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11675 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11676 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11677 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11678 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11679 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11680 rfc5424 convention.
11681
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011682maxconn <maxconn>
11683 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11684 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11685 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11686 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11687 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11688 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11689 eat all memory.
11690
11691mode <mode>
11692 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11693 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11694 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11695 UNIX sockets.
11696
11697mss <maxseg>
11698 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11699 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11700 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11701 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11702 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11703 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11704 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11705 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11706 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11707 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11708 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11709
11710name <name>
11711 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11712 page.
11713
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011714namespace <name>
11715 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11716 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11717 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11718 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11719
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011720nice <nice>
11721 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11722 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11723 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11724 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11725 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11726 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11727 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11728 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11729 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11730 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11731 one for an RDP socket.
11732
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011733no-ca-names
11734 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11735 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11736
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011737no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011738 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011739 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011740 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011741 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011742 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11743 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011744
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011745no-tls-tickets
11746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11747 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11748 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011749 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11750 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011751
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011752no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011754 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011755 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011756 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011757 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11758 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011759
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011760no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011762 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011763 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011764 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011765 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11766 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011767
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011768no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011770 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011771 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011772 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011773 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11774 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011775
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011776no-tlsv13
11777 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11778 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11779 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11780 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011781 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11782 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011783
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011784npn <protocols>
11785 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11786 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11787 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011788 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011789 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011790 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11791 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11792 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11793 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11794 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011795
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011796prefer-client-ciphers
11797 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11798 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11799 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011800 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11801 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11802 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011803
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011804process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011805 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011806 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011807 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011808 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11809 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11810 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11811 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011812 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011813 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11814 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11815 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11816 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11817 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011818
11819 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11820
11821 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11822 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11823 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11824 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11825 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11826 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11827 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11828 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011829
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011830proto <name>
11831 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11832 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11833 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11834 in haproxy -vv.
11835 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11836 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011837 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011838 h2" on the bind line.
11839
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011840ssl
11841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011842 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011843 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11844 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011845 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11846 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011847
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011848ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11849 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11850 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11851 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11852
11853ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11854 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11855 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11856 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11857
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011858strict-sni
11859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11860 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11861 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11862 See the "crt" option for more information.
11863
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011864tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011865 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011866 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11867 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011868 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011869 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11870 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11871 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11872 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11873 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11874 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11875 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11876
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011877tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011878 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011879 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11880 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11881 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11882 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11883 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11884 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11885 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011886 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11887 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11888 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011889
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011890tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11891 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011892 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11893 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11894 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11895 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11896 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11897 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11898 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11899 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11900 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11901 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011902 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11903 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11904
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011905transparent
11906 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11907 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11908 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11909 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11910 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11911 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11912 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11913 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11914 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11915 so check for support with your vendor.
11916
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011917v4v6
11918 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11919 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11920 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11921 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011922 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011923
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011924v6only
11925 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11926 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11927 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011928 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11929 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011930
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011931uid <uid>
11932 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11933 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11934 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11935 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11936 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11937
11938user <user>
11939 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11940 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11941 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11942 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11943 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11944
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011945verify [none|optional|required]
11946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11947 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11948 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11949 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11950 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011951 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11952 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11953 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11954 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011955
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200119565.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011957------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011958
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011959The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11960which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11961arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11962settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11963after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11964Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11965address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011967 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011968 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011969
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011970Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11971keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011973The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011974
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011975addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011976 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011977 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11978 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11979 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11980 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11981 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011982
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011983agent-check
11984 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011985 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011986 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11987 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11988 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011989
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011990 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011991 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011992 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11993 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11994 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011995
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011996 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11997 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11998 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11999 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12000 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012001
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012002 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012003 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012004
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012005 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12006 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12007 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012008
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012009 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12010 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12011 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012012
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012013 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12014 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12015 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12016 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12017 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012018 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012019 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012020
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012021 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12022 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012023
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012024 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12025 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12026 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12027 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12028 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12029 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12030 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12031 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12032 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012033
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012034 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12035 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012036 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12037 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12038 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012039 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012040
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012041 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012042 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012043
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012044agent-send <string>
12045 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12046 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12047 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12048 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12049 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12050
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012051agent-inter <delay>
12052 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12053 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12054
12055 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12056 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12057 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12058 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12059 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12060 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12061 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12062 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12063 of backends use the same servers.
12064
12065 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12066
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012067agent-addr <addr>
12068 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12069
12070 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12071 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12072 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12073 hostname, it will be resolved.
12074
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012075agent-port <port>
12076 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12077
12078 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12079
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012080allow-0rtt
12081 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012082 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12083 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012084
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012085alpn <protocols>
12086 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12087 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12088 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012089 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012090 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12091 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12092 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12093 now obsolete NPN extension.
12094 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12095 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12096
12097 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012099backup
12100 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12101 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12102 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12103 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012104 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12105 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012106
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012107ca-file <cafile>
12108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12109 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12110 server's certificate.
12111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012112check
12113 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012114 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12115 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12116 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12117 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12118 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12119 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12120 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012121 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12122 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012123 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12124 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012125
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012126check-send-proxy
12127 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12128 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12129 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12130 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12131 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12132 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12133 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12134
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012135check-alpn <protocols>
12136 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12137 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12138 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12139
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012140check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012141 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012142 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12143 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012144
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012145check-ssl
12146 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12147 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12148 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12149 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012150 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012151 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12152 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012153 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012154 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12155 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012156
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012157check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012158 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012159 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12160 for normal traffic.
12161
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012162ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12164 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12165 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012166 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12167 information and recommendations see e.g.
12168 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12169 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12170 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012171
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012172ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12174 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12175 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12176 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012177 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12178 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12179 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012181cookie <value>
12182 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12183 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12184 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12185 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12186 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12187 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12188 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12189
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012190crl-file <crlfile>
12191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12192 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12193 to verify server's certificate.
12194
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012195crt <cert>
12196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12197 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12198 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12199 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12200 certificate request.
12201
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012202disabled
12203 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12204 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12205 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12206 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12207 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012208 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012209
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012210enabled
12211 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12212 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12213 default value.
12214 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12215 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012217error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012218 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12219 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12220 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012222 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012223
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012224fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012225 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12226 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12227 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12228
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012229force-sslv3
12230 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12231 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012232 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012233 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012234
12235force-tlsv10
12236 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012237 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012238 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012239
12240force-tlsv11
12241 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012242 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012243 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012244
12245force-tlsv12
12246 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012247 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012248 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012249
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012250force-tlsv13
12251 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12252 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012253 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012255id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012256 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12257 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12258 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012259
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012260init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12261 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12262 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012263 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012264 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12265 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12266 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12267 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12268 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12269 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12270 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12271 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12272 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012273 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012274 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12275 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12276 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12277 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12278 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12279 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012280 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012281
12282 Example:
12283 defaults
12284 # never fail on address resolution
12285 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012287inter <delay>
12288fastinter <delay>
12289downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012290 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12291 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12292 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12293 between checks depending on the server state :
12294
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012295 Server state | Interval used
12296 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12297 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12298 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12299 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12300 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12301 or yet unchecked. |
12302 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12303 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12304 | "inter" otherwise.
12305 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012307 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12308 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12309 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12310 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012311 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12312 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12313 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12314 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12315 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012317maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012318 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12319 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012320 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12321 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012322 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12323 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12324 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12325 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12326
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012327 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12328 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12329 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12330 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12331 than 50 concurrent requests.
12332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012333maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012334 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12335 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12336 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12337 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12338 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12339 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12340 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12341
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012342max-reuse <count>
12343 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12344 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12345 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12346 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12347 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12348 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12349 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12350 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012352minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012353 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12354 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12355 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12356 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12357 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12358 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012359 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012360 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012361
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012362namespace <name>
12363 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12364 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12365 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12366 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12367
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012368no-agent-check
12369 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12370 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12371 default value.
12372 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12373 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12374
12375no-backup
12376 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12377 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12378 default value.
12379 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12380 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12381
12382no-check
12383 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12384 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12385 default value.
12386 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12387 "default-server" "check" setting.
12388
12389no-check-ssl
12390 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12391 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12392 default value.
12393 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12394 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12395
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012396no-send-proxy
12397 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12398 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12399 default value.
12400 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12401 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12402
12403no-send-proxy-v2
12404 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12405 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12406 default value.
12407 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12408 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12409
12410no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12411 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12412 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12413 default value.
12414 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12415 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12416
12417no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12418 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12419 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12420 default value.
12421 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12422 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12423
12424no-ssl
12425 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12426 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12427 default value.
12428 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12429 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12430
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012431no-ssl-reuse
12432 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12433 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12434 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12435 and for paranoid users.
12436
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012437no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012438 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12439 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012440 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012441
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012442 Supported in default-server: No
12443
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012444no-tls-tickets
12445 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12446 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12447 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012448 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12449 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012450 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012451
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012452no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012453 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012454 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12455 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012456 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12457 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012458 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012459
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012460 Supported in default-server: No
12461
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012462no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012463 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012464 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12465 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012466 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12467 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012468 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012469
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012470 Supported in default-server: No
12471
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012472no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012473 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012474 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12475 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012476 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12477 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012478 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012479
12480 Supported in default-server: No
12481
12482no-tlsv13
12483 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12484 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12485 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12486 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12487 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012488 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012489
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012490 Supported in default-server: No
12491
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012492no-verifyhost
12493 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12494 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12495 default value.
12496 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12497 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012498
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012499no-tfo
12500 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12501 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12502 default value.
12503 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12504 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12505
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012506non-stick
12507 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12508 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12509 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12510
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012511npn <protocols>
12512 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12513 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12514 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012515 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012516 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12517 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12518 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012520observe <mode>
12521 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12522 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12523 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12524 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12525 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12526 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012527 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012528
12529 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012531on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012532 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12533 Currently, four modes are available:
12534 - fastinter: force fastinter
12535 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12536 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12537 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12538 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12539
12540 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12541
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012542on-marked-down <action>
12543 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12544 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012545 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12546 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12547 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12548 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12549 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12550 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12551 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12552 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012553
12554 Actions are disabled by default
12555
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012556on-marked-up <action>
12557 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12558 Currently one action is available:
12559 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12560 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12561 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12562 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012563 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12564 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012565 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12566 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12567
12568 Actions are disabled by default
12569
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012570pool-max-conn <max>
12571 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12572 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12573 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12574 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12575 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12576 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12577
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012578pool-purge-delay <delay>
12579 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012580 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012581 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012583port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012584 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12585 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12586 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12587 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12588 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12589 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12590
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012591proto <name>
12592
12593 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12594 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12595 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12596 reported in haproxy -vv.
12597 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12598 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012600redir <prefix>
12601 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12602 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12603 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12604 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12605 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12606 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12607 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12608 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012609 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012610 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012611 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12612 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12613 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12614 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12615
12616 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12617
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012618rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012619 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12620 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12621 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12622
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012623resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12624 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12625 server.
12626
12627 Available options:
12628
12629 * allow-dup-ip
12630 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12631 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12632 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12633 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12634 For such case, simply enable this option.
12635 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12636
12637 * prevent-dup-ip
12638 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12639 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12640 same fqdn.
12641 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12642
12643 Example:
12644 backend b_myapp
12645 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12646 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12647 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12648
12649 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12650 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12651 it
12652 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12653 different address
12654
12655 Default value: not set
12656
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012657resolve-prefer <family>
12658 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12659 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12660 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12661 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12662
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012663 Default value: ipv6
12664
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012665 Example:
12666
12667 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012668
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012669resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012670 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012671 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012672 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012673 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12674 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012675 configured network, another address is selected.
12676
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012677 Example:
12678
12679 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012680
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012681resolvers <id>
12682 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12683 hostname.
12684
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012685 Example:
12686
12687 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012688
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012689 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012690
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012691send-proxy
12692 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12693 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12694 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12695 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012696 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12697 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12698 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12699 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12700 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12701 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12702 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12703 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12704 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12705 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012706 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12707 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012708
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012709send-proxy-v2
12710 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12711 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12712 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12713 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012714 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12715 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12716 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12717 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012718
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012719proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12720 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12721 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012722 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12723 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012724 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12725 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012726 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012727
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012728send-proxy-v2-ssl
12729 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12730 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12731 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12732 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12733 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12734 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12735 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012736 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12737 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012738
12739send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12740 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12741 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12742 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12743 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12744 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12745 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12746 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12747 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012748 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12749 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012751slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012752 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12753 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12754 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12755 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12756 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12757 parameters :
12758
12759 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12760 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12761
12762 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12763 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12764 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12765 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12766
12767 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12768 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12769 seen as failed.
12770
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012771sni <expression>
12772 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12773 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12774 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12775 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012776 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12777 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012778 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012779 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12780 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012781
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012782source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012783source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012784source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012785 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12786 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12787 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12788 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12789
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012790 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12791 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12792 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12793 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12794 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12795 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12796 server.
12797
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012798 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12799 specifying the source address without port(s).
12800
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012801ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012802 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12803 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12804 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12805 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12806 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12807 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012808 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12809 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012810
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012811ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12812 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12813 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12814 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12815
12816ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12817 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12818 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12819 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12820
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012821ssl-reuse
12822 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12823 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12824 default value.
12825 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12826 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12827
12828stick
12829 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12830 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12831 default value.
12832 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12833 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012834
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012835socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012836 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012837 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12838 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12839
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012840tcp-ut <delay>
12841 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12842 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12843 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012844 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012845 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12846 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12847 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12848 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12849 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12850 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12851 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12852 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12853 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12854
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012855tfo
12856 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12857 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12858 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12859 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12860 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012861 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012863track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012864 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12865 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12866 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12867 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012868 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12869
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012870tls-tickets
12871 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12872 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12873 default value.
12874 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12875 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012876
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012877verify [none|required]
12878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012879 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012880 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12881 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012882 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012883 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12884 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12885 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12886 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12887 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12888 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12889 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12890 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012891
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012892verifyhost <hostname>
12893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012894 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12895 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12896 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12897 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12898 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12899 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12900 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12901 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012903weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012904 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12905 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12906 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012907 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12908 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12909 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12910 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12911 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12912 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012913
12914
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129155.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12916-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012917
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012918HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12919using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12920configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012921This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12922can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12923workload.
12924This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12925resolution at run time.
12926Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12927carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12928
12929
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129305.3.1. Global overview
12931----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012932
12933As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12934different steps of the process life:
12935
12936 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12937 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12938 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12939
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012940 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12941 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012942
12943A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12944 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12945 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12946 resolution to know this new IP.
12947
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012948When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012949HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012950SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12951from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12952will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12953will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012954
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012955A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012956 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012957 first valid response.
12958
12959 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12960 servers return an error.
12961
12962
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129635.3.2. The resolvers section
12964----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012965
12966This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012967HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12968contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012969
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012970When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12971uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12972is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12973answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12974
12975When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012976used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012977
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012978 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12979 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12980 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012981
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012982 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12983 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012984
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012985 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12986 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12987 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012988
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012989For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12990following scenarios are possible:
12991
12992 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12993 ignored
12994
12995 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12996 applied
12997
12998 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12999 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13000
13001 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13002 retries the query with a new type
13003
13004 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13005 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013006
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013007As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13008a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013009<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013010
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013011
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013012resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013013 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013014
13015A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13016
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013017accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013018 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013019 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013020 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13021 by RFC 6891)
13022
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013023 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13024
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013025nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13026 DNS server description:
13027 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13028 <ip> : IP address of the server
13029 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13030
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013031parse-resolv-conf
13032 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13033 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13034 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13035
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013036hold <status> <period>
13037 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13038 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013039 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013040 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013041 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13042 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13043 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13044
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013045 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013046
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013047resolve_retries <nb>
13048 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13049 giving up.
13050 Default value: 3
13051
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013052 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13053 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13054 type.
13055
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013056timeout <event> <time>
13057 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13058 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13059 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013060 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13061 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013062 Default value: 1s
13063 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013064 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013065 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013066 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13067 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13068
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013069 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013070
13071 resolvers mydns
13072 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13073 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013074 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013075 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013076 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013077 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013078 hold other 30s
13079 hold refused 30s
13080 hold nx 30s
13081 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013082 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013083 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013084
13085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130866. HTTP header manipulation
13087---------------------------
13088
13089In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13090response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13091request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13092which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013093against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013094
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013095If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13096to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13097but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13098HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13099stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13100because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13101a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13102still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013104This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13105in section 4.2 :
13106
13107 - reqadd <string>
13108 - reqallow <search>
13109 - reqiallow <search>
13110 - reqdel <search>
13111 - reqidel <search>
13112 - reqdeny <search>
13113 - reqideny <search>
13114 - reqpass <search>
13115 - reqipass <search>
13116 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13117 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13118 - reqtarpit <search>
13119 - reqitarpit <search>
13120 - rspadd <string>
13121 - rspdel <search>
13122 - rspidel <search>
13123 - rspdeny <search>
13124 - rspideny <search>
13125 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13126 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13127
13128With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13129is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13130parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13131prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13132Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13133
13134 \t for a tab
13135 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13136 \n for a new line (LF)
13137 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13138 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13139 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13140 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13141 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13142
13143The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13144portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13145above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13146regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
131479 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13148is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13149
13150The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13151after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13152
13153Notes related to these keywords :
13154---------------------------------
13155 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13156 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13157 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13158
13159 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13160 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13161 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13162
13163 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13164 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13165 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13166 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13167 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13168
13169 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13170 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13171 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13172 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13173 useless headers before adding new ones.
13174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013175 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013176 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13177
13178 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13179 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13180 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13181
13182 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13183 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013184 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013185
13186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131877. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13188----------------------------------
13189
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013190HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013191client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13192The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13193these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13194but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13195data called patterns.
13196
13197
131987.1. ACL basics
13199---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013200
13201The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13202content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13203from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13204simple :
13205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013206 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013207 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13209 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13212adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013213
13214In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013216 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013217
13218This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13219Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13220and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013221an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13222conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13223as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13224are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013225
13226ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13227'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13228which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13229
13230There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13231performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013233The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13234specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13235this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013236methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13237ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013238
13239Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13240 - boolean
13241 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13242 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13243 - string
13244 - data block
13245
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013246Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13247converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13248would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13249The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13250which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13251
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013252Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13253keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13254fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13255which are summarized in the table below :
13256
13257 +---------------------+-----------------+
13258 | Sample or converter | Default |
13259 | output type | matching method |
13260 +---------------------+-----------------+
13261 | boolean | bool |
13262 +---------------------+-----------------+
13263 | integer | int |
13264 +---------------------+-----------------+
13265 | ip | ip |
13266 +---------------------+-----------------+
13267 | string | str |
13268 +---------------------+-----------------+
13269 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13270 +---------------------+-----------------+
13271
13272Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13273matching method, see below.
13274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013275The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13276 - boolean
13277 - integer or integer range
13278 - IP address / network
13279 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13280 - regular expression
13281 - hex block
13282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013283The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13284
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013285 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13286 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013287 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013288 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013289 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013290 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013291 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13294read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13295if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13296lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13297will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13298beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13299a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13300lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13301exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13302
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013303The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13304parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13305ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13306a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13307check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13308
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013309The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13310socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13311file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013313Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13314loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13315
13316 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13317
13318In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13319the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13320case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13321as well.
13322
13323The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13324sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13325do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13326methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13327is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013328obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013329followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13330default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13331that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13332string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13333
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013334The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13335By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13336string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13337resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13338server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013339waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013340flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13341function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013343There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13344sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13345be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013346
13347 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13348 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013349 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13350 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13351 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13352 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013353
13354 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13355 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013356 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013357
13358 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013359 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013360
13361 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013363
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013364 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013365 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13366
13367 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13368 binary or string samples.
13369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13371 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013373 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13374 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13375 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013377 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13378 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013380 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13381 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013383 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13384 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013386 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13387 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013388 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13391 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13392 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013393
13394For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13395request, it is possible to do :
13396
13397 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13398
13399In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13400buffer, one would use the following acl :
13401
13402 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13403
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013404On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13405possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13406
13407 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013409All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13410criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13411method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13412to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13413criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13414the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013416If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013417the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13418For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13421 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13422 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13423 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013424
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013425
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013426The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13427types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13428combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13429brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13430default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013432 +-------------------------------------------------+
13433 | Input sample type |
13434 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013435 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013436 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13437 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13438 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013439 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013440 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013441 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013442 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013443 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013444 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013445 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013446 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013447 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013448 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013449 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013450 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013451 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013452 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013453 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013454 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013455 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013457 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013458 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013459 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13461 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13462 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013463
13464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134657.1.1. Matching booleans
13466------------------------
13467
13468In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13469Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13470When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13471that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13472
13473Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13474return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13475"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13476
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134787.1.2. Matching integers
13479------------------------
13480
13481Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13482enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13483to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13484
13485Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13486matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13487lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013488
13489For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13490unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13491representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13492
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013493As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13494two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13495instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13496ranges and operators.
13497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013498For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013499operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13500Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13501of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013502
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013503Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013504
13505 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13506 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13507 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13508 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13509 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013511For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013512
13513 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13514
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013515This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13516
13517 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13518
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135207.1.3. Matching strings
13521-----------------------
13522
13523String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13524different forms :
13525
13526 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013527 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013528
13529 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013530 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531
13532 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13533 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13534
13535 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13536 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13537
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013538 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013539 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13540 matches.
13541
13542 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13543 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13544 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013545
13546String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13547exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13548characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13549string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13550to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013551before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013552
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013553Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13554(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13555Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13556
13557Example:
13558 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13559 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135627.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13563---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013564
13565Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13566they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13567possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13568passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13569the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013570the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13571match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013572
13573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13575-------------------------------------
13576
13577It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13578not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13579a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13580to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13581digits may be used upper or lower case.
13582
13583Example :
13584 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13585 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13586
13587
135887.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13589---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013590
13591IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13592netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13593within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013594host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013595difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13596at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13597does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13598parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013599
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013600The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13601abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13602
13603 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13604 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13605 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13606 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13607 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13608 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13609 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13610 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13611
13612Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13613192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13614
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013615IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13616Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13617trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13618IPv6 patterns.
13619
13620HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13621following situations :
13622 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13623 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13624 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13625 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13626 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13627 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13628 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13629 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13630 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13631 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013633
136347.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13635----------------------------------
13636
13637Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13638combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13639
13640 - AND (implicit)
13641 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13642 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013644A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013646 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013648Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13649indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013651For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13652"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13653requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13654is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13655
13656 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013657 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13658 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13659 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013660
13661To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13662and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13663
13664 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13665 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13666 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13667 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013669 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013670 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13671 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13672 use_backend www if host_www
13673
13674It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13675expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13676be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13677the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13678
13679 The following rule :
13680
13681 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013682 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013683
13684 Can also be written that way :
13685
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013686 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013687
13688It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13689to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13690simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13691sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13692good use is the following :
13693
13694 With named ACLs :
13695
13696 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13697 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13698 monitor fail if site_dead
13699
13700 With anonymous ACLs :
13701
13702 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13703
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013704See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13705keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013706
13707
137087.3. Fetching samples
13709---------------------
13710
13711Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13712against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13713sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13714ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13715of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13716available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13717
13718This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13719Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13720compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13721deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13722
13723The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13724matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13725method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13726indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13727
13728As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13729when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13730mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13731the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13732ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13733
13734Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13735multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13736when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013737incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13738are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013739is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13740all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13741
13742Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13743 - name
13744 - name(arg1)
13745 - name(arg1,arg2)
13746
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013747
137487.3.1. Converters
13749-----------------
13750
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013751Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13752of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13753is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13754was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013755has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013756unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13757
13758These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13759sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13760the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013761support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013762
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013763A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13764support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13765supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13766(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13767bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013769The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013770
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001377151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13772 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13773 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13774 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13775 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13776 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13777
13778 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013779 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13780 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013781 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13782 frontend http-in
13783 bind *:8081
13784 default_backend servers
13785 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13786 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13787
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013788add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013789 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013790 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013791 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13792 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013793 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013794 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13795 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13796 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13797 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013798 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013799 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013800
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013801aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13802 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13803 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13804 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13805 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13806 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13807 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13808
13809 Example:
13810 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13811 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13812
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013813and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013814 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013815 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013816 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13817 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013818 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013819 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13820 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13821 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13822 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013823 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013824 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013825
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013826b64dec
13827 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13828 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13829
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013830base64
13831 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013832 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013833 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13834
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013835bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013836 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013837 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013838 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013839 presence of a flag).
13840
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013841bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13842 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13843 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013844 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013845
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013846concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13847 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13848 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13849 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13850 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13851 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13852 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13853 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13854 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13855 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13856 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013857 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013858 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013859 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013860
13861 Example:
13862 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13863 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13864 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13865 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13866
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013867cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013868 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13869 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013870
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013871crc32([<avalanche>])
13872 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13873 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13874 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13875 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13876 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13877 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13878 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13879 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13880 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13881 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013882 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13883
13884crc32c([<avalanche>])
13885 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13886 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13887 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13888 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13889 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13890 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13891 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13892 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013893
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013894da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013895 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13896 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13897 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13898 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013899 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013900 configuration language.
13901
13902 Example:
13903 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013904 bind *:8881
13905 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013906 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013907
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013908debug
13909 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13910 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13911 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13912
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013913div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013914 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13915 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013916 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013917 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13918 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013919 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013920 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13921 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13922 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13923 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013924 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013925 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013926
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013927djb2([<avalanche>])
13928 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13929 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13930 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13931 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13932 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13933 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13934 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013935 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13936 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013937
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013938even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013939 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013940 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13941
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013942field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13943 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13944 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13945 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13946 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13947 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13948 fields.
13949
13950 Example :
13951 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13952 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13953 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13954 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13955 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013956
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013957hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013958 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013959 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013960 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013961 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013962
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013963hex2i
13964 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013965 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013966
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013967http_date([<offset>])
13968 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13969 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13970 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13971 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13972 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13973 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013975in_table(<table>)
13976 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13977 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13978 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013979 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013980 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13981
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013982ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13983 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013984 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013985 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13986 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13987 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13988 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13989 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013990
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013991json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013992 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013993 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013994 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013995 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13996 of errors:
13997 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13998 bytes, ...)
13999 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14000 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14001
14002 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14003 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14004 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14005 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14006 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14007 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014008 - "ascii" : never fails;
14009 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14010 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014011 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014012 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014013 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14014 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14015
14016 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014017 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014018
14019 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014020 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014021 capture request header user-agent len 150
14022 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014023
14024 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14025 GET / HTTP/1.0
14026 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14027
14028 Output log:
14029 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14030
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014031language(<value>[,<default>])
14032 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14033 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14034 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14035 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14036 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14037 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14038 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14039 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14040 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014041 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014042 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14043 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014044
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014045 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014046
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014047 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14048 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014049
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014050 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14051 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14052 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14053 use_backend spanish if es
14054 use_backend french if fr
14055 use_backend english if en
14056 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014057
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014058length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014059 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14060 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14061 type. The result is of type integer.
14062
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014063lower
14064 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14065 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14066 type. The result is of type string.
14067
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014068ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14069 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14070 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14071 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14072 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14073 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14074 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14075
14076 Example :
14077
14078 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014079 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014080 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14081
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014082map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14083map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14084map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14085 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14086 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14087 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14088 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14089 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14090 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14091 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14092 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014093
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014094 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14095 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14096 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014097
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014098 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014099 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014100
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014101 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14102 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14103 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14104 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014105 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14106 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014107 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14108 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14109 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14110 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14111 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14112 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14113 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14114 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014115 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14116 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14117 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014118 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14119 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14120 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14121 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14122 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014123
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014124 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14125 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14126 the corresponding match text.
14127
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014128 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14129 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14130 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14131 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14132 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014133
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014134 Example :
14135
14136 # this is a comment and is ignored
14137 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14138 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14139 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14140 | | | `---------- value
14141 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14142 | `---------------------------- key
14143 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14144
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014145mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014146 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14147 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014148 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014149 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014150 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014151 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14152 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14153 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14154 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014155 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014156 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014157
14158mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014159 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014160 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14161 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014162 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014163 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014164 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014165 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14166 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14167 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14168 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014169 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014170 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014171
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014172nbsrv
14173 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14174 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14175 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14176 map lookup.
14177
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014178neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014179 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14180 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14181 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14182 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014183
14184not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014185 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014186 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014187 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014188 absence of a flag).
14189
14190odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014191 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014192 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14193
14194or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014195 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014196 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014197 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14198 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014199 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014200 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14201 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14202 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14203 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014204 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014205 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014206
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014207protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14208 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14209 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14210 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14211 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14212 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14213 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14214 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14215 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14216 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14217 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14218 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14219
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014220regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014221 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14222 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14223 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14224 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14225 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14226 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14227 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14228 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14229 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14230 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014231 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14232 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14233 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14234 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014235
14236 Example :
14237
14238 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14239 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14240 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14241 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14242
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014243capture-req(<id>)
14244 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14245 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14246
14247 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014248 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14249 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014250
14251capture-res(<id>)
14252 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14253 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14254
14255 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014256 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14257 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014258
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014259sdbm([<avalanche>])
14260 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14261 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14262 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14263 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14264 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14265 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14266 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014267 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14268 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014269
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014270set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014271 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14272 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14273 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014274 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014275 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14276 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014277 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014278 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14279 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014280 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014281 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014282
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014283sha1
14284 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14285 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14286
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014287strcmp(<var>)
14288 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14289 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14290 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14291 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14292 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14293 shorter).
14294
14295 Example :
14296
14297 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14298 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14299 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14300
14301
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014302sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014303 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14304 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014305 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014306 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14307 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014308 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014309 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14310 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014311 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014312 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14313 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014314 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014315 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014316
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014317table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14318 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14319 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14320 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14321 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14322 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14323 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14324
14325
14326table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14327 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14328 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14329 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14330 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14331 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14332 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14333
14334table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14335 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14336 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014337 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014338 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14339 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14340
14341table_conn_cur(<table>)
14342 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14343 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14344 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14345 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14346 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14347
14348table_conn_rate(<table>)
14349 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14350 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14351 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14352 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14353 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14354
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014355table_gpt0(<table>)
14356 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14357 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14358 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14359 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14360 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14361
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014362table_gpc0(<table>)
14363 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14364 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14365 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14366 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14367 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14368
14369table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14370 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14371 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14372 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14373 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14374 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14375 sample fetch keyword.
14376
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014377table_gpc1(<table>)
14378 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14379 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14380 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14381 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14382 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14383
14384table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14385 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14386 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14387 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14388 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14389 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14390 sample fetch keyword.
14391
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014392table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14393 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14394 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014395 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014396 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14397 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14398
14399table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14400 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14401 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14402 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14403 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14404 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14405 keyword.
14406
14407table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14408 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14409 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014410 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014411 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14412 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14413
14414table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14415 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14416 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14417 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14418 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14419 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14420 keyword.
14421
14422table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14423 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14424 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014425 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014426 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14427 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14428 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14429 keyword.
14430
14431table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14432 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14433 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014434 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014435 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14436 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14437 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14438 keyword.
14439
14440table_server_id(<table>)
14441 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14442 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14443 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14444 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14445 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14446 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14447
14448table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14449 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14450 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014451 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014452 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14453 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14454 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14455 keyword.
14456
14457table_sess_rate(<table>)
14458 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14459 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14460 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14461 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14462 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14463 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14464 keyword.
14465
14466table_trackers(<table>)
14467 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14468 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14469 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14470 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14471 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14472 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14473 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14474 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14475 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14476 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14477
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014478upper
14479 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14480 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14481 type. The result is of type string.
14482
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014483url_dec
14484 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14485 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14486
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014487ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014488 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014489 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14490 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14491 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014492 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14493 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14494 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14495 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014496 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014497 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14498 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014499
14500 Example:
14501 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14502 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14503
14504 message Point {
14505 int32 latitude = 1;
14506 int32 longitude = 2;
14507 }
14508
14509 message PPoint {
14510 Point point = 59;
14511 }
14512
14513 message Rectangle {
14514 // One corner of the rectangle.
14515 PPoint lo = 48;
14516 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14517 PPoint hi = 49;
14518 }
14519
14520 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14521 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14522 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14523
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014524 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14525 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014526 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014527 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14528
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014529 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014530
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014531 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014532
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014533 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014534 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14535 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14536
14537 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14538 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14539 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14540
14541 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14542 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14543 interpret the previous binary sample.
14544
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014545
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014546unset-var(<var name>)
14547 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14548 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14549 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14550 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14551 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14552 response),
14553 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14554 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14555 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14556 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14557
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014558utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14559 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14560 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14561 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14562 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14563 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14564 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14565
14566 Example :
14567
14568 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014569 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014570 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14571
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014572word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14573 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14574 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14575 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14576 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14577 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14578
14579 Example :
14580 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14581 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14582 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14583 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14584 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014585
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014586wt6([<avalanche>])
14587 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14588 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14589 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14590 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14591 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14592 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14593 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014594 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14595 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014596
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014597xor(<value>)
14598 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014599 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014600 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014601 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014602 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014603 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14604 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014605 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014606 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14607 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014608 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014609 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014610
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014611xxh32([<seed>])
14612 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14613 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14614 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14615 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14616 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14617 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14618 as cryptographically secure.
14619
14620xxh64([<seed>])
14621 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14622 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14623 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14624 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14625 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14626 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14627 as cryptographically secure.
14628
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146307.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014631--------------------------------------------
14632
14633A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14634not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14635"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14636The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14637
14638always_false : boolean
14639 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14640 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14641
14642always_true : boolean
14643 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14644 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14645
14646avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014647 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14649 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14650 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14651 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14652 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14653 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14654 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14655 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14656 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14657 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14658 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14659 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14660 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014662be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014663 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14664 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14665 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14666 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014667 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14668
14669be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14670 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14671 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14672 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14673 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14674 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014675 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14676 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014677
14678 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14679 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14680 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014682be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14683 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14684 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14685 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014686 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014687 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14688 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014689
14690 Example :
14691 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14692 backend dynamic
14693 mode http
14694 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14695 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014696
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014697bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014698 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14699 of the string.
14700
14701bool(<bool>) : bool
14702 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14703 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014705connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14706 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014707 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014708 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14709 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014710
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014711 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014712 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014713 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14714
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014715 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14716 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014717
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014718 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014719 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014720 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014721 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014722 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014723 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014724 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014725
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014726 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14727 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014728 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014729 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014730
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014731cpu_calls : integer
14732 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14733 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14734 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14735 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14736 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14737 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14738
14739cpu_ns_avg : integer
14740 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14741 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14742 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14743 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14744 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14745 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14746 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14747 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14748 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14749 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14750 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14751
14752cpu_ns_tot : integer
14753 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14754 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14755 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14756 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14757 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14758 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14759 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14760 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14761 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14762 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14763 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14764 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14765 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14766
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014767date([<offset>]) : integer
14768 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14769 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14770 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14771 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014772 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14773
14774 Example :
14775
14776 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14777 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014778
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014779date_us : integer
14780 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14781 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14782 from the same timeval structure.
14783
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014784distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14785 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14786 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14787 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14788 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14789 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14790 list of supported tokens.
14791
14792distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14793 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14794 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14795 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14796 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14797 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14798 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14799 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14800 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14801 supported tokens.
14802
14803 Example :
14804 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14805 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14806 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14807 # send large files to the big farm
14808 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14809
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014810env(<name>) : string
14811 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14812 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14813 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14814 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14815 certain way.
14816
14817 Examples :
14818 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14819 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14820
14821 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14822 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14825 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014826 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14827 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14829 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014830 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14832 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014833
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014834fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14835 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14836 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14837 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014839fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14840 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14841 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14842 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14843 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14844 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14845 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14846 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14847 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014848
14849 Example :
14850 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14851 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14852 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14853 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14854 frontend mail
14855 bind :25
14856 mode tcp
14857 maxconn 100
14858 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14859 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14860 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14861 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014862
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014863hostname : string
14864 Returns the system hostname.
14865
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014866int(<integer>) : signed integer
14867 Returns a signed integer.
14868
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014869ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14870 Returns an ipv4.
14871
14872ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14873 Returns an ipv6.
14874
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014875lat_ns_avg : integer
14876 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14877 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14878 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14879 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14880 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14881 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14882 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14883 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14884 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14885 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14886 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14887 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14888 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14889 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14890
14891lat_ns_tot : integer
14892 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14893 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14894 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14895 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14896 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14897 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14898 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14899 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14900 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14901 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14902 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14903 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14904 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14905 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14906 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14907 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14908 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14909 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14910 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14911
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014912meth(<method>) : method
14913 Returns a method.
14914
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014915nbproc : integer
14916 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14917 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14918 and debugging purposes.
14919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14922 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14923 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014924 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14925 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14926 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014927
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014928prio_class : integer
14929 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14930 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14931 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14932
14933prio_offset : integer
14934 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14935 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14936 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14937 set-priority-offset".
14938
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014939proc : integer
14940 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14941 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14942 debugging purposes.
14943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014944queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014945 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14946 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14947 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14949 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14950 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14951 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14952 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14953
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014954rand([<range>]) : integer
14955 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14956 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14957 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14958 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14959 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14960
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014961uuid([<version>]) : string
14962 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14963 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14964 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014966srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14967 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14968 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14969 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14970 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14971 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014972 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14973 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14974
14975srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14976 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14977 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14978 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14979 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14980 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14981 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14982 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14983
14984 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14985 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014986
14987srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14988 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14989 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14990 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014991 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014992 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14993 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14994 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14995
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014996srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14997 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14998 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14999 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15000 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15001 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15002 fetch methods.
15003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15005 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15006 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015007 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015008 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15009 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015010 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011 overloading servers).
15012
15013 Example :
15014 # Redirect to a separate back
15015 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15016 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15017 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15018
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015019stopping : boolean
15020 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15021 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15022 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15023
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015024str(<string>) : string
15025 Returns a string.
15026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15028 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15029 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15030
15031table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15032 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15033 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15034 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15035
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015036thread : integer
15037 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15038 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15039 and debugging purposes.
15040
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015041var(<var-name>) : undefined
15042 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015043 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15044 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015045 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015046 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15047 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015048 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015049 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15050 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015051 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015052 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015053
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150547.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015055----------------------------------
15056
15057The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15058closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15059methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15060sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15061TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015062the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15063counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015064"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15065used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15066can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15067Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15068table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15069tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15070currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015072bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015073 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15074 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15075 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077be_id : integer
15078 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15079 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15080
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015081be_name : string
15082 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15083 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015085dst : ip
15086 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15087 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15088 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15089 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015090 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15091 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15092 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15093 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15094 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15095 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015096
15097dst_conn : integer
15098 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15099 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15100 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15101 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15102 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15103 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15104 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15105 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015106
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015107dst_is_local : boolean
15108 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15109 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15110 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15111 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015112 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015113 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15114 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15115 it only once per connection.
15116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015117dst_port : integer
15118 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15119 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15120 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15121 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15122 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15123 an HTTP header.
15124
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015125fc_http_major : integer
15126 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15127 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15128 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15129
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015130fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15131 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15132 header.
15133
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015134fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15135 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15136 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15137 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15138 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15139 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15140 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15141
15142fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15143 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15144 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15145 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15146 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15147 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15148 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15149
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015150fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015151 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15152 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15153 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15154 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15155
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015156fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015157 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15158 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15159 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15160 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15161
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015162fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015163 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15164 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15165 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15166 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15167
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015168fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015169 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15170 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15171 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15172 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15173
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015174fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015175 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15176 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15177 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15178 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15179
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015180fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015181 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15182 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15183 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15184 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15185
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015186fe_defbe : string
15187 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15188 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015190fe_id : integer
15191 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015192 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15194
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015195fe_name : string
15196 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15197 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15198 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15199
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015200sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015201sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15202sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15203sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015204 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15205 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15206 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15207
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015208sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015209sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15210sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15211sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015212 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15213 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15214 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15215
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015216sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015217sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15218sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15219sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015220 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15221 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015222 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15223 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15224 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015225
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015226 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015227 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15228 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015229 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15230 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15231 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015232 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15233 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15234
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015235sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15236sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15237sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15238sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15239 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15240 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15241 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15242 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15243 when a first ACL was verified.
15244
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015245sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015246sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15247sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15248sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015249 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015250 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15251
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015252sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015253sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15254sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15255sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015256 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15257 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15258 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15259
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015260sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015261sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15262sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15263sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015264 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15265 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15266 See also src_conn_rate.
15267
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015268sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015269sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15270sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15271sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015272 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015273 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015274
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015275sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15276sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15277sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15278sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15279 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15280 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15281
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015282sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15283sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15284sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15285sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15286 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15287 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15288
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015289sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015290sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15291sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15292sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015293 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15294 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15295 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015296 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15297 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15298 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015299
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015300sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15301sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15302sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15303sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15304 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15305 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15306 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15307 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15308 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15309 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15310
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015311sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015312sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15313sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15314sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015315 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015316 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15317 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15318
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015319sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015320sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15321sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15322sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015323 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15324 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15325 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15326 src_http_err_rate.
15327
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015328sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015329sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15330sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15331sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015332 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015333 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15334 src_http_req_cnt.
15335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015336sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015337sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15338sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15339sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015340 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15341 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15342 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15343 src_http_req_rate.
15344
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015345sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015346sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15347sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15348sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015349 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015350 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15351 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15352 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15353 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015354
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015355 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015356 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15357 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015358 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15359
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015360sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15361sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15362sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15363sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15364 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15365 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15366 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15367 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15368 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015370sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015371sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15372sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15373sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015374 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15375 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15376 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015378sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015379sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15380sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15381sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015382 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15383 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15384 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015386sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015387sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15388sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15389sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015390 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015391 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15392 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15393 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015394 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015395 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15396
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015397sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015398sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15399sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15400sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015401 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15402 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15403 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15404 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15405 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015406 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015408sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015409sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15410sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15411sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015412 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15413 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15414 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15415
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015416sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015417sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15418sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15419sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015420 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15421 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015422 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015423 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15424 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15426 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15427 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429so_id : integer
15430 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15431 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15432 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015434src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015435 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015436 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15437 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15438 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015439 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15440 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15441 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015442 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15443 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15444 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15445 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15446 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15447 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15448 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015449
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015450 Example:
15451 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15452 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15455 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15456 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15457 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015458 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15461 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15462 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015463 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015464 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15467 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15468 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15469 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15470 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15471 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15472 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015473
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015474 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015475 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15476 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15477 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15478 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015479 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015480 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15481 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15482
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015483src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15484 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15485 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15486 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15487 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15488 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15489 was verified.
15490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015492 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015494 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015495 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015497src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015498 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015499 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15500 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015501 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15504 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15505 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15506 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015507 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015510 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015512 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015513 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015514
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015515src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15516 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15517 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15518 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15519 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15520
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015521src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15522 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15523 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15524 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15525 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015528 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015530 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15531 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015532 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15533 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15534 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015535
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015536src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15537 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15538 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15539 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15540 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15541 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15542 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15543 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015546 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015548 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015549 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15553 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15554 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15555 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15556 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015557 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015559src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015560 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15562 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015563 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15566 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15567 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15568 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015569 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015570 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15573 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15574 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15575 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015576 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15578 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015579
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015580 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015581 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015582 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015583 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015584
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015585src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15586 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15587 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15588 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15589 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15590 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15591 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15592
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015593src_is_local : boolean
15594 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15595 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15596 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15597 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015598 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015599 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15600 once per connection.
15601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015603 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15604 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15605 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15606 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15607 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015610 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15611 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15612 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15613 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15614 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616src_port : integer
15617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15618 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15619 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15620 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015623 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015624 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15625 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15626 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015627 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15630 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15631 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15632 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15633 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015634 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15637 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15638 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15639 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15640 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15641 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15642 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15643 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15644 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015645
15646 Example :
15647 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15648 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15649 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15650 listen ssh
15651 bind :22
15652 mode tcp
15653 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015654 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015656 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658srv_id : integer
15659 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15660 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15661 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015662
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156637.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15667closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15668when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15669usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015670future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015671
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001567251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15673 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15674 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15675 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15676 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15677 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15678
15679 Example :
15680 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15681 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15682 # the request.
15683 frontend http-in
15684 bind *:8081
15685 default_backend servers
15686 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15687 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15688
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015689ssl_bc : boolean
15690 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15691 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15692 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15693
15694ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15695 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15696 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15697
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015698ssl_bc_alpn : string
15699 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15700 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015701 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015702 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15703 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15704 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15705 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15706 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15707 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15708
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015709ssl_bc_cipher : string
15710 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15711 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15712
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015713ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15714 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15715 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15716 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15717
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015718ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15719 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15720 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15721 session or a TLS ticket.
15722
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015723ssl_bc_npn : string
15724 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15725 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015726 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015727 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15728 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15729 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15730 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15731 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15732
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015733ssl_bc_protocol : string
15734 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15735 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15736
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015737ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015738 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015739 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15740 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015741
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015742ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15743 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15744 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15745 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15746
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015747ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15748 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15749 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15750 if session was reused or not.
15751
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015752ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15753 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15754 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15755 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15756 BoringSSL.
15757
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015758ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15759 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15760 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15763 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15764 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15765 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15766 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15767 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15770 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15771 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15772 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15773 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015774
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015775ssl_c_der : binary
15776 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15777 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15778 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780ssl_c_err : integer
15781 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15782 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15783 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15784 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15785 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015787ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15788 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15789 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15790 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15791 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15792 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15793 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15794 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15795 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797ssl_c_key_alg : string
15798 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15799 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15800 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802ssl_c_notafter : string
15803 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15804 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15805 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807ssl_c_notbefore : string
15808 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15809 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15810 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15813 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15814 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15815 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15816 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15817 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15818 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15819 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15820 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822ssl_c_serial : binary
15823 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15824 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15825 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015827ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15828 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15829 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15830 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015831 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15832 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15833
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015834 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015835 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15838 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15839 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15840 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842ssl_c_used : boolean
15843 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15844 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015846ssl_c_verify : integer
15847 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15848 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15849 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15850 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852ssl_c_version : integer
15853 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15854 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015855
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015856ssl_f_der : binary
15857 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15858 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15859 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015861ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15862 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15863 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15864 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15865 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015866 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15868 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15869 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871ssl_f_key_alg : string
15872 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15873 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15874 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876ssl_f_notafter : string
15877 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15878 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15879 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881ssl_f_notbefore : string
15882 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15883 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15884 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15887 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15888 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15889 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15890 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15891 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15892 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15893 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15894 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896ssl_f_serial : binary
15897 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15898 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15899 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015900
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015901ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15902 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15903 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15904 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15907 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15908 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15909 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911ssl_f_version : integer
15912 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15913 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15914
15915ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015916 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15917 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15918 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920 Example :
15921 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15922 listen http-https
15923 bind :80
15924 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15925 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15926
15927ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15928 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15929 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15930
15931ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015932 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15934 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15935 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15936 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15937 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15938 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15939 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15940 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942ssl_fc_cipher : string
15943 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15944 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015945
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015946ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15947 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15948 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015949 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015950
15951ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15952 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15953 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015954 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015955
15956ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15957 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15958 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15959 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015960 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015961 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015962
15963ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15964 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15965 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015966 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015967
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015968ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15969 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15970 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15971 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015974 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15975 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015976 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15977 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15978 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15979 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015980
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015981ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15982 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15983 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15984 wait until the handshake happened.
15985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15987 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015988 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15989 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015990 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015991 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015992
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015993ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015994 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015995 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15996 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015998ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015999 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016000 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16001 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16002 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16003 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16004 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16005 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16006 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008ssl_fc_protocol : string
16009 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16010 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016011
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016012ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016013 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016014 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16015 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016016
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016017ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16018 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16019 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16020 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16023 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16024 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16025 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16026 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016027
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016028ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16029 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16030 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16031 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16032 BoringSSL.
16033
16034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035ssl_fc_sni : string
16036 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16037 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16038 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16039 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16040 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16041
16042 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16043 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16044 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016045 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016046 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016048 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16050 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016052ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16053 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16054 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016055
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016056
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160577.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016060Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16061sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16062only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16063For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16064be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16065can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16066sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16067for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16068content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016071 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16073 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16076 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016077 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016079
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016080req.hdrs : string
16081 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16082 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16083 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16084 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16085
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016086req.hdrs_bin : binary
16087 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16088 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16089 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16090 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16091 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16092 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16093
16094 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16095
16096 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16097 str: <int:length><bytes>
16098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016099req.len : integer
16100req_len : integer (deprecated)
16101 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16102 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16103 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16104 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16105 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16106 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16107 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16108 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016110req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16111 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016112 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16113 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16114 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16115 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016117 ACL alternatives :
16118 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16121 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16122 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16123 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16124 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126 ACL alternatives :
16127 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016131req.proto_http : boolean
16132req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16133 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16134 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16135 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16136 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16137 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16138 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16139 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016141 Example:
16142 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16143 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16144 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016145 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016147req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16148rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16149 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16150 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16151 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16152 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16153 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16154 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16155 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16158 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16159 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16160 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16161 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16162 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164 ACL derivatives :
16165 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016167 Example :
16168 listen tse-farm
16169 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16170 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16171 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16172 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16173 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16174 persist rdp-cookie
16175 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16176 # This is only useful makes sense if
16177 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16178 stick-table type string size 204800
16179 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16180 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16181 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16184 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16187rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16188 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16189 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16190 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16191 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193 ACL derivatives :
16194 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016195
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016196req.ssl_alpn : string
16197 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16198 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16199 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16200 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16201 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16202 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016203 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016204
16205 Examples :
16206 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16207 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16208 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016209 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016210 default_backend bk_default
16211
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016212req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16213 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16214 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016215 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16216 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16217 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16218 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16219 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016221req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16222req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16223 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16224 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16225 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16226 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16227 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16228 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16229 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231req.ssl_sni : string
16232req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16233 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16234 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16235 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16236 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16237 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16238 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16239 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16240 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16241 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16242 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16243 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16244 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246 ACL derivatives :
16247 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 Examples :
16250 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16251 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16252 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16253 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16254 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016255
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016256req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16257 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16258 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16259 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16260 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16261 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16262 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16263 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16264 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16265 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267req.ssl_ver : integer
16268req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16269 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16270 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16271 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16272 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16273 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16274 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16275 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016276 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016277 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279 ACL derivatives :
16280 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016281
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016282res.len : integer
16283 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16284 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16285 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16286 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16287 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16288 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16289 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16290 content inspection.
16291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016292res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16293 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016294 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16295 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16296 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16297 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016299res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16300 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16301 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16302 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16303 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016305 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016306
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016307res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16308rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16309 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16310 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16311 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16312 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16313 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16314 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16315 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016317wait_end : boolean
16318 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16319 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016320 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016321 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16322 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016323 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016324 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16325 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016327 Examples :
16328 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16329 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16330 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016332 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16333 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16334 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16335 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16336 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16337 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16338 tcp-request content reject
16339
16340
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163417.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342--------------------------------------
16343
16344It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16345This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16346data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16347its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16348HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16349content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16350to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16351more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16352response are indexed.
16353
16354base : string
16355 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16356 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16357 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16358 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16359 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16360 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16361 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16362 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16363
16364 ACL derivatives :
16365 base : exact string match
16366 base_beg : prefix match
16367 base_dir : subdir match
16368 base_dom : domain match
16369 base_end : suffix match
16370 base_len : length match
16371 base_reg : regex match
16372 base_sub : substring match
16373
16374base32 : integer
16375 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16376 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16377 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016378 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16379 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16380 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016381
16382base32+src : binary
16383 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16384 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16385 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16386 per-URL counters.
16387
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016388capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16389 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16390 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16391 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16392
16393capture.req.method : string
16394 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16395 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16396 because it's allocated.
16397
16398capture.req.uri : string
16399 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16400 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16401 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16402 allocated.
16403
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016404capture.req.ver : string
16405 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16406 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16407 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16408
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016409capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16410 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16411 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16412 The first entry is an index of 0.
16413 See also: "capture response header"
16414
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016415capture.res.ver : string
16416 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16417 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16418 persistent flag.
16419
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016420req.body : binary
16421 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16422 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16423 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16424 the first chunk is analyzed.
16425
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016426req.body_param([<name>) : string
16427 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16428 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16429 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16430 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16431 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16432 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16433 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16434 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16435 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16436 given.
16437
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016438req.body_len : integer
16439 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16440 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16441 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16442 "option http-buffer-request".
16443
16444req.body_size : integer
16445 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16446 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16447 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16448 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16449 "option http-buffer-request".
16450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016451req.cook([<name>]) : string
16452cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16453 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16454 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16455 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16456 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16457 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16458 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16459 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16460 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16461
16462 ACL derivatives :
16463 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16464 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16465 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16466 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16467 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16468 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16469 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16470 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016472req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16473cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16474 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16475 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16478cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16479 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16480 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16481 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16482 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016484cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16485 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16486 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16487 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16488 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016489 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016490 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16491 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16492 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16493 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016495hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16496 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16497 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16498 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16499 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016500 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16503 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16504 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16505 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16506 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16507 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16508 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16509 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16510 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016512req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16513 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16514 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16515 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16516 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016518req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16519 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16520 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16521 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16522 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16523 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16524 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16525 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16526 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016527 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016528 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016529 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016531 ACL derivatives :
16532 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16533 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16534 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16535 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16536 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16537 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16538 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16539 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16540
16541req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16542hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16543 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16544 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16545 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16546 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16547 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16548 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16549 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16550 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16551 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16552
16553req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16554hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16555 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16556 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16557 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16558 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16559 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016560 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016561 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16562 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16563
16564req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16565hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16566 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16567 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16568 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16569 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16570 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16571 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16572 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16573
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016574
16575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016576http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16577 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16578 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16579 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16580 basic auth is supported.
16581
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016582http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16583 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16584 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16585 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16586 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016587 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16588 basic auth is supported.
16589
16590 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016591 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16592 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16593 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16594 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595
16596http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016597 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16598 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016599 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16600 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016602method : integer + string
16603 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16604 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16605 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16606 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16607 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16608 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16609 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016611 ACL derivatives :
16612 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614 Example :
16615 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16616 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16617 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016619path : string
16620 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16621 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16622 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16623 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16624 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016625 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016626 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016628 ACL derivatives :
16629 path : exact string match
16630 path_beg : prefix match
16631 path_dir : subdir match
16632 path_dom : domain match
16633 path_end : suffix match
16634 path_len : length match
16635 path_reg : regex match
16636 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016637
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016638query : string
16639 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16640 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16641 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16642 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016643 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016644 which stops before the question mark.
16645
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016646req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16647 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16648 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16649 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16650 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016652req.ver : string
16653req_ver : string (deprecated)
16654 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16655 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16656 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016658 ACL derivatives :
16659 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016661res.comp : boolean
16662 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16663 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16664 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016666res.comp_algo : string
16667 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16668 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16669 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016671res.cook([<name>]) : string
16672scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16673 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16674 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16675 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016677 ACL derivatives :
16678 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016680res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16681scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16682 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16683 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16684 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016686res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16687scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16688 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16689 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16690 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016692res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16693 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16694 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16695 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16696 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16697 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16698 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16699 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16700 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16701 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016703res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16704 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16705 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16706 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16707 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16708 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016710res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16711shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16712 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16713 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16714 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16715 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16716 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16717 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16718 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16719 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016721 ACL derivatives :
16722 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16723 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16724 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16725 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16726 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16727 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16728 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16729 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16730
16731res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16732shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16733 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16734 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16735 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16736 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16737 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016739res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16740shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16741 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16742 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16743 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16744 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16745 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16746 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016747
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016748res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16749 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16750 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16751 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16752 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16755shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16756 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16757 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16758 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16759 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16760 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16761 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016763res.ver : string
16764resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16765 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16766 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768 ACL derivatives :
16769 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16772 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16773 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016774 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016777 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16778 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016780status : integer
16781 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16782 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16783 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016784
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016785unique-id : string
16786 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16787 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16788 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16789 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16790 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16791 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016793url : string
16794 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16795 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16796 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16797 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16798 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16799 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16800 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016802 ACL derivatives :
16803 url : exact string match
16804 url_beg : prefix match
16805 url_dir : subdir match
16806 url_dom : domain match
16807 url_end : suffix match
16808 url_len : length match
16809 url_reg : regex match
16810 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016812url_ip : ip
16813 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16814 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16815 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16816 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16817 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16818 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16819 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821url_port : integer
16822 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16823 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16824 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16825 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016826
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016827urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16828url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016829 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16830 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016831 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16832 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16833 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16834 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016835 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16836 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016837 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16838 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016840 ACL derivatives :
16841 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16842 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16843 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16844 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16845 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16846 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16847 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16848 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016849
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016851 Example :
16852 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16853 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16854 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16855 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016856
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016857urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016858 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16859 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16860 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016861
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016862url32 : integer
16863 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16864 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16865 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16866 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16867 is an unsigned integer.
16868
16869url32+src : binary
16870 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16871 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16872 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16873
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200168757.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016876---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016878Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16879every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016880order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016882ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16883---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016884FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016885HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016886HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16887HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016888HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16889HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16890HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16891HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16892LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016893METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016894METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016895METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16896METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16897METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16898METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016899METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016900METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016901RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016902REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016903TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016904WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16905---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016906
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169088. Logging
16909----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016910
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016911One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16912provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16913very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16914provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16915state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016916to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016917headers.
16918
16919In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16920about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16921send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16922
16923 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16924 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16925 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16926 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16927 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016928 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016929 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016930
16931The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16932allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16933as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16934while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16935real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16936delay.
16937
16938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169398.1. Log levels
16940---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016941
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016942TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016943source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016944HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16945in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16946track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16947syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16948about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016949
16950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169518.2. Log formats
16952----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016953
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016954HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016955and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16956slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16957options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016958
16959 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16960 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16961 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16962 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16963 extents.
16964
16965 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16966 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16967 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16968 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16969 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16970
16971 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16972 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16973 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16974 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16975 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16976
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016977 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16978 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16979 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16980 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16981
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016982 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16983
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016984Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16985specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16986field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16987servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16988always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16989identifier.
16990
16991Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16992 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16993 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16994 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16995 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16996
16997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169988.2.1. Default log format
16999-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017000
17001This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17002as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17003format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17004
17005 Example :
17006 listen www
17007 mode http
17008 log global
17009 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17010
17011 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17012 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17013 (www/HTTP)
17014
17015 Field Format Extract from the example above
17016 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17017 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17018 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17019 4 'to' to
17020 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17021 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17022
17023Detailed fields description :
17024 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17025 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17026 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17027 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17028 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17029 and processed the connection.
17030 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17031
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017032In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17033"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17034connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17035
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017036It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17037will eventually disappear.
17038
17039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170408.2.2. TCP log format
17041---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017042
17043The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17044is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17045information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17046counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17047emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17048environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17049the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17050sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017051specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17052not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17053fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17054marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017055
17056 Example :
17057 frontend fnt
17058 mode tcp
17059 option tcplog
17060 log global
17061 default_backend bck
17062
17063 backend bck
17064 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17065
17066 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17067 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17068 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17069
17070 Field Format Extract from the example above
17071 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17072 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17073 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17074 4 frontend_name fnt
17075 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17076 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17077 7 bytes_read* 212
17078 8 termination_state --
17079 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17080 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17081
17082Detailed fields description :
17083 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017084 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17085 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17086 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017087 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017088 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017089 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017090
17091 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017092 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17093 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17094 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017095
17096 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17097 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17098 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017099 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17100 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17101 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17102 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017103
17104 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17105 and processed the connection.
17106
17107 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17108 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17109 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17110 applications.
17111
17112 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17113 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17114 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17115 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17116 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17117
17118 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17119 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17120 See "Timers" below for more details.
17121
17122 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17123 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17124 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17125 "Timers" below for more details.
17126
17127 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017128 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017129 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17130 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17131 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17132 details.
17133
17134 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17135 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17136 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17137 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17138 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17139
17140 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17141 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17142 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17143 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17144 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17145 for more details.
17146
17147 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017148 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017149 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17150 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17151 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017152 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017153
17154 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17155 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17156 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17157 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17158 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17159 caused by a denial of service attack.
17160
17161 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17162 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17163 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17164 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17165 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17166 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17167 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17168 denial of service attack.
17169
17170 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17171 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17172 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17173 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17174 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17175 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17176 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17177 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17178 be processed than on other servers.
17179
17180 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17181 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17182 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17183 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17184 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17185 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17186 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17187 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17188 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17189 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17190 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17191 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17192 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17193
17194 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17195 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17196 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17197 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17198 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17199 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017200 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017201 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17202
17203 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17204 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17205 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17206 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17207 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17208 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017209 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017210 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17211 occurs.
17212
17213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172148.2.3. HTTP log format
17215----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017216
17217The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17218is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17219the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17220are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17221emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17222generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17223"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17224which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017225frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17226is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017227
17228Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17229slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17230with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17231
17232 Example :
17233 frontend http-in
17234 mode http
17235 option httplog
17236 log global
17237 default_backend bck
17238
17239 backend static
17240 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17241
17242 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17243 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17244 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017245 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017246
17247 Field Format Extract from the example above
17248 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17249 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017250 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017251 4 frontend_name http-in
17252 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017253 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017254 7 status_code 200
17255 8 bytes_read* 2750
17256 9 captured_request_cookie -
17257 10 captured_response_cookie -
17258 11 termination_state ----
17259 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17260 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17261 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17262 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17263 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017264
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017265Detailed fields description :
17266 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017267 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17268 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17269 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017270 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017271 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017272 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017273
17274 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017275 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17276 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17277 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017278
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017279 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17280 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017281
17282 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17283 and processed the connection.
17284
17285 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17286 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17287 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17288
17289 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17290 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17291 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17292 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17293 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17294 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17295
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017296 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17297 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17298 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017299 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017300 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17301 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017302 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17303 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017304
17305 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17306 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017307 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017308
17309 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17310 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017311 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17312 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017313
17314 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17315 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17316 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17317 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17318 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017319 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17320 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017321
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017322 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17323 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17324 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17325 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17326 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17327 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17328 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017329 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017330
17331 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17332 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17333 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17334
17335 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17336 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017337 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017338 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17339 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17340 overflowing.
17341
17342 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17343 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17344 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17345 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17346 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17347 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17348 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17349 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17350
17351 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17352 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17353 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17354 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17355 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17356 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17357 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17358 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17359
17360 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17361 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17362 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17363 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17364 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17365 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17366 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17367
17368 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017369 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017370 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17371 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17372 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017373 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017374 system.
17375
17376 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17377 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17378 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17379 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17380 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17381 caused by a denial of service attack.
17382
17383 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17384 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17385 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17386 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17387 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17388 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17389 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17390 denial of service attack.
17391
17392 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17393 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17394 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17395 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17396 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17397 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17398 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17399 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17400 processed than on other servers.
17401
17402 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17403 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17404 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17405 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17406 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17407 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17408 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17409 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17410 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17411 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17412 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17413 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17414 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17415
17416 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17417 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17418 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17419 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17420 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17421 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017422 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017423 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17424
17425 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17426 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17427 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17428 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17429 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17430 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017431 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017432 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17433 occurs.
17434
17435 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17436 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17437 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17438 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17439 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17440 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17441 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17442 cookies" below for more details.
17443
17444 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17445 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17446 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17447 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17448 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17449 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17450 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17451 and cookies" below for more details.
17452
17453 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17454 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17455 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17456 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17457 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17458 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17459 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17460 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17461
17462
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200174638.2.4. Custom log format
17464------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017465
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017466The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017467mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017468
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017469HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017470Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17471separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17472prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17473
17474Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17475variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017476("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017477
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017478If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017479as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017480less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17481the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17482
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017483Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017484In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017485in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017486
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017487Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17488'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17489https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17490such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17491
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017492Flags are :
17493 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017494 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017495 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17496 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017497
17498 Example:
17499
17500 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17501 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17502
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017503 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17504
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017505At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17506
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017507 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17508 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017509
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017510the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017511
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017512 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17513 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17514 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017515
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017516and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17517
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017518 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17519 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017520
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017521Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17522
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017523 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017524 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017525 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17526 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17527 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017528 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17529 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17530 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017531 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017532 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17533 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017534 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017535 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17536 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017537 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017538 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017539 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017540 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017541 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017542 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017543 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017544 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17545 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17546 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17547 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17548 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017549 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017550 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17551 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017552 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017553 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17554 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017555 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17556 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17557 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017558 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017559 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17560 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017561 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017562 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17563 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17564 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017565 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017566 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017567 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17568 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17569 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17570 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017571 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017572 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017573 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017574 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017575 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017576 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017577 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17578 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17579 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017580 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017581 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17582 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017583 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017584 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17585 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017586 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017587 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017588 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017589 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017590
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017591 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017592
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017593
175948.2.5. Error log format
17595-----------------------
17596
17597When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17598protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17599By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17600"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017601will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017602logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17603
17604The format looks like this :
17605
17606 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17607 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17608 Connection error during SSL handshake
17609
17610 Field Format Extract from the example above
17611 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17612 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17613 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17614 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17615 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17616
17617These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17618failures.
17619
17620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176218.3. Advanced logging options
17622-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017623
17624Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17625just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17626options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17627for more information about their usage.
17628
17629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176308.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17631------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017632
17633It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17634haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17635commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17636monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17637ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17638
17639 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17640 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17641 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17642 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17643
17644 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17645 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17646 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017647 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017648 such as other load-balancers.
17649
17650 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17651 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17652 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17653
17654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176558.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17656----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017657
17658The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17659what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17660or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017661"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017662just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17663log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17664after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17665is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17666with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17667with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17668
17669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176708.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17671------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017672
17673Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17674for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17675"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17676retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17677raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17678a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17679file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17680you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17681"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17682
17683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17685--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017686
17687Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17688multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17689them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17690"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17691logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17692error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17693and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17694too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17695useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17696alternative.
17697
17698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176998.4. Timing events
17700------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017701
17702Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17703reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17704the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17705frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017706mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17707addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17708
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017709Timings events in HTTP mode:
17710
17711 first request 2nd request
17712 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17713 t tr t tr ...
17714 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17715 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17716 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17717 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17718 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17719
17720Timings events in TCP mode:
17721
17722 TCP session
17723 |<----------------->|
17724 t t
17725 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17726 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17727 |<------ Tt ------->|
17728
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017729 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017730 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017731 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17732 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17733 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017734 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017735 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17736 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17737 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17738 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017739
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017740 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17741 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17742 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017743 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17744 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17745 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17746 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17747 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17748 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017749
17750 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17751 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17752 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17753 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17754 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17755 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17756 request typed by hand during a test.
17757
17758 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17759 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017760 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017761 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17762 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17763 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17764 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017765
17766 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17767 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17768 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17769 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17770 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17771
17772 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17773 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17774 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17775 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17776 connection never established.
17777
17778 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17779 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17780 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17781 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17782 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17783 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17784 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17785 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17786 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17787 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17788 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17789
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017790 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17791 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17792 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17793 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17794 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17795 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17796
17797 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17798
17799 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17800 "Ta" can never be negative.
17801
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017802 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17803 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017804 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17805 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017806 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017807
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017808 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017809
17810 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017811 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17812 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017813
17814These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17815protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17816that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017817due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17818"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17819that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017820
17821Most common cases :
17822
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017823 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17824 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17825 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17826 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17827 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17828 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17829 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17830 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17831 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17832 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17833 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017834 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017835
17836 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17837 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17838 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17839 of ms on remote networks.
17840
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017841 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17842 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17843 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017844
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017845 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17846 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17847 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17848 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17849 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17850 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17851 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17852 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17853 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017854
17855Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17856
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017857 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017858 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017859 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017860
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017861 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017862 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17863 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17864
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017865 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017866 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17867 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17868 flags.
17869
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017870 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17871 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017872 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17873 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17874 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17875 the client connection was maintained open.
17876
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017877 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017878 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017879 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017880 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17881
17882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178838.5. Session state at disconnection
17884-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017885
17886TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17887"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
178882-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17889each of which has a special meaning :
17890
17891 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17892 session to terminate :
17893
17894 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17895
17896 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17897 server explicitly refused it.
17898
17899 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17900 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17901 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17902 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017903 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017904
17905 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17906 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017907
17908 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17909 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17910 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17911 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17912 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17913
17914 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17915 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17916 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17917 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17918 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17919
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017920 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17921 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17922
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017923 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17924 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17925 backup connections when going up.
17926
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017927 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017929 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17930 send or receive data.
17931
17932 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17933 send or receive data.
17934
17935 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17936 with nothing left in the buffers.
17937
17938 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17939
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017940 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017941 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17942
17943 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17944 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17945 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17946 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17947 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17948
17949 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17950 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17951
17952 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17953 server (HTTP only).
17954
17955 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17956
17957 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17958 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17959 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17960
17961 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17962 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17963 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17964
17965 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17966
17967 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17968 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17969
17970 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17971 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17972 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17973
17974 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17975 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017976 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17977 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017978
17979 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17980 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17981 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17982 another server.
17983
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017984 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017985 server.
17986
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017987 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17988 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17989 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17990 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17991
17992 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17993 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17994 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17995 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17996
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017997 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17998 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17999 "use-server" rule).
18000
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018001 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18002
18003 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18004 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18005
18006 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18007
18008 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18009 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18010 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18011
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018012 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18013 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018014 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018015 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18016 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18017
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018018 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18019
18020 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18021 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18022
18023 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18024
18025 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18026
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018027The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18028was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018029helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18030starvation, attacks, etc...
18031
18032The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18033alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18034easier finding and understanding.
18035
18036 Flags Reason
18037
18038 -- Normal termination.
18039
18040 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18041 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18042 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18043 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18044
18045 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18046 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18047 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18048 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18049 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18050 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018051
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018052 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18053 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018054 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018055
18056 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18057 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18058 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18059
18060 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18061 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18062 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18063 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18064 the server takes too long to respond.
18065
18066 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18067 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18068 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18069 long a time to respond.
18070
18071 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18072 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18073 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18074 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018075 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18076 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018077
18078 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18079 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18080 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18081 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18082 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018083 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018084 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18085 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18086 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18087 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18088 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18089 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18090 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18091 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018092 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018093 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18094 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18095 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018096
18097 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18098 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018099 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18100 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18101 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18102 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018104 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18105 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018107 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018108 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18109 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018110 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018111 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18112 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18113
18114 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18115 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18116 503 or 504 here.
18117
18118 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18119 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18120 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18121 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18122 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18123
18124 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18125 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018126 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018127 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18128 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18129
18130 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18131 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18132 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18133 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18134 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18135 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18136 between haproxy and the server.
18137
18138 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18139 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18140 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18141 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18142 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18143 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18144 solution is to fix the application.
18145
18146 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18147 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18148 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18149 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18150 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18151 external attacks.
18152
18153 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18154 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018155 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018156 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18157 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18158
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018159 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18160 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18161 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018162 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018163 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018164
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018165 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18166 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18167 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18168 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018169 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18170 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18171 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18172 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18173 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018174
18175 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18176 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18177 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18178 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18179
18180 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18181 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18182 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18183 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18184
18185 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18186 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18187 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18188 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18189
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018190The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18191persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18192important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18193re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18194
18195 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18196
18197 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18198 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18199 set on a GET request.
18200
18201 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18202 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018203 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018204 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18205
18206 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18207 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18208 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18209
18210 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18211 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18212 already got a cookie.
18213
18214 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18215 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18216 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18217 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18218 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18219
18220 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18221 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18222 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18223
18224 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18225 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18226 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18227
18228 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18229 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18230
18231 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18232 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18233 then advertised in the response.
18234
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182368.6. Non-printable characters
18237-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018238
18239In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18240consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18241converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18242prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18243being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18244escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18245is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18246'}' when logging headers.
18247
18248Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18249issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18250containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18251
18252Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18253the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18254performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18255
18256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182578.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18258---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018259
18260Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18261achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018262section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018263cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18264the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18265the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018266locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018267not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18268user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18269a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18270wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18271
18272 Examples :
18273 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18274 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18275
18276 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18277 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18278
18279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182808.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18281---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018282
18283Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18284proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18285the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18286server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18287
18288Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18289response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018290section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018291
18292It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018293time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18294appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018295are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18296and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18297follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18298request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18299in the logs.
18300
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018301As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18302frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18303an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18304
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018305 Example :
18306 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18307 listen proxy-out
18308 mode http
18309 option httplog
18310 option logasap
18311 log global
18312 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18313
18314 # log the name of the virtual server
18315 capture request header Host len 20
18316
18317 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18318 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18319
18320 # log the beginning of the referrer
18321 capture request header Referer len 20
18322
18323 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18324 capture response header Server len 20
18325
18326 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18327 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18328
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018329 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018330 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18331
18332 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18333 capture response header Via len 20
18334
18335 # log the URL location during a redirection
18336 capture response header Location len 20
18337
18338 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18339 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18340 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18341 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18342 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18343
18344 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18345 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18346 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18347 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018348 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018349
18350 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18351 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18352 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18353 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18354 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018355 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018356
18357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183588.9. Examples of logs
18359---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018360
18361These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18362them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18363reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18364
18365 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18366 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18367 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18368
18369 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18370 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18371
18372 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18373 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18374 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18375
18376 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18377 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18378
18379 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18380 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18381 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18382
18383 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018384 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018385 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18386 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18387
18388 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18389 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18390 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18391
18392 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18393 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018394 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018395 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18396 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18397 to return the 502 and not the server.
18398
18399 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018400 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018401
18402 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18403 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18404 Nothing was sent to any server.
18405
18406 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18407 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18408
18409 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18410 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018411 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018412 send a 408 return code to the client.
18413
18414 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18415 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18416
18417 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18418 5 seconds ("c----").
18419
18420 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18421 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018422 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018423
18424 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018425 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018426 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18427 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18428 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18429 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18430 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018431
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018432
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200184339. Supported filters
18434--------------------
18435
18436Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18437accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18438unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18439
18440See also : "filter"
18441
184429.1. Trace
18443----------
18444
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018445filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018446
18447 Arguments:
18448 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18449 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18450
18451 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18452 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18453 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18454 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18455
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018456 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018457 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18458 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18459 amount of the parsed data.
18460
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018461 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018462
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018463This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18464callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18465information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18466filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18467
18468Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18469tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18470a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18471
18472
184739.2. HTTP compression
18474---------------------
18475
18476filter compression
18477
18478The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18479keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018480when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18481it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18482response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18483line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18484cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18485the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018486
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018487See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018488
18489
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200184909.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18491--------------------------------------------
18492
18493filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18494
18495 Arguments :
18496
18497 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18498 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18499 parsed.
18500
18501 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18502 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18503 part must be placed in its own scope.
18504
18505The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18506external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018507streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018508exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18509also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18510
18511SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18512the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18513
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018514For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018515"doc/SPOE.txt".
18516
18517Important note:
18518 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18519 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18520
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100185219.4. Cache
18522----------
18523
18524filter cache <name>
18525
18526 Arguments :
18527
18528 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18529
18530The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18531"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018532cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018533other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18534the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18535mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18536filter other than the compression is used for the same
18537listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18538order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018539
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018540See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018541
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001854210. Cache
18543---------
18544
18545HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18546(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18547RAM.
18548
18549The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018550this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018551
18552If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18553independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18554when we try to allocate a new one.
18555
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018556The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018557
18558It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18559"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18560for more details.
18561
18562When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18563replaced by "<CACHE>".
18564
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001856510.1. Limitation
18566----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018567
18568The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18569
18570- If the response is not a 200
18571- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018572- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018573- If the response is not cacheable
18574
18575- If the request is not a GET
18576- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018577- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018578
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018579Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18580filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18581can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18582example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18583"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018584
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001858510.2. Setup
18586-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018587
18588To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18589the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18590
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001859110.2.1. Cache section
18592---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018593
18594cache <name>
18595 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18596 size of cache is mandatory.
18597
18598total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018599 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018600 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018601
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018602max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018603 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18604 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18605 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018606
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018607max-age <seconds>
18608 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18609 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18610 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18611 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18612 default.
18613
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001861410.2.2. Proxy section
18615---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018616
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018617http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018618 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18619 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18620 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18621 after this one.
18622
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018623http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018624 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18625 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18626 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18627 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18628
18629
18630Example:
18631
18632 backend bck1
18633 mode http
18634
18635 http-request cache-use foobar
18636 http-response cache-store foobar
18637 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18638
18639 cache foobar
18640 total-max-size 4
18641 max-age 240
18642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018643/*
18644 * Local variables:
18645 * fill-column: 79
18646 * End:
18647 */